]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/config/alpha/alpha.c
7305f6fbb26a54326bdc62ad4547d2f4bfee3b0c
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / config / alpha / alpha.c
1 /* Subroutines used for code generation on the DEC Alpha.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 Contributed by Richard Kenner (kenner@vlsi1.ultra.nyu.edu)
6
7 This file is part of GCC.
8
9 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
10 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
11 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
12 any later version.
13
14 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
15 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
16 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
17 GNU General Public License for more details.
18
19 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
20 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
21 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
22
23
24 #include "config.h"
25 #include "system.h"
26 #include "coretypes.h"
27 #include "tm.h"
28 #include "rtl.h"
29 #include "tree.h"
30 #include "regs.h"
31 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
32 #include "insn-config.h"
33 #include "conditions.h"
34 #include "output.h"
35 #include "insn-attr.h"
36 #include "flags.h"
37 #include "recog.h"
38 #include "expr.h"
39 #include "optabs.h"
40 #include "reload.h"
41 #include "obstack.h"
42 #include "except.h"
43 #include "function.h"
44 #include "diagnostic-core.h"
45 #include "ggc.h"
46 #include "integrate.h"
47 #include "tm_p.h"
48 #include "target.h"
49 #include "target-def.h"
50 #include "common/common-target.h"
51 #include "debug.h"
52 #include "langhooks.h"
53 #include "splay-tree.h"
54 #include "cfglayout.h"
55 #include "gimple.h"
56 #include "tree-flow.h"
57 #include "tree-stdarg.h"
58 #include "tm-constrs.h"
59 #include "df.h"
60 #include "libfuncs.h"
61 #include "opts.h"
62
63 /* Specify which cpu to schedule for. */
64 enum processor_type alpha_tune;
65
66 /* Which cpu we're generating code for. */
67 enum processor_type alpha_cpu;
68
69 static const char * const alpha_cpu_name[] =
70 {
71 "ev4", "ev5", "ev6"
72 };
73
74 /* Specify how accurate floating-point traps need to be. */
75
76 enum alpha_trap_precision alpha_tp;
77
78 /* Specify the floating-point rounding mode. */
79
80 enum alpha_fp_rounding_mode alpha_fprm;
81
82 /* Specify which things cause traps. */
83
84 enum alpha_fp_trap_mode alpha_fptm;
85
86 /* Nonzero if inside of a function, because the Alpha asm can't
87 handle .files inside of functions. */
88
89 static int inside_function = FALSE;
90
91 /* The number of cycles of latency we should assume on memory reads. */
92
93 int alpha_memory_latency = 3;
94
95 /* Whether the function needs the GP. */
96
97 static int alpha_function_needs_gp;
98
99 /* The assembler name of the current function. */
100
101 static const char *alpha_fnname;
102
103 /* The next explicit relocation sequence number. */
104 extern GTY(()) int alpha_next_sequence_number;
105 int alpha_next_sequence_number = 1;
106
107 /* The literal and gpdisp sequence numbers for this insn, as printed
108 by %# and %* respectively. */
109 extern GTY(()) int alpha_this_literal_sequence_number;
110 extern GTY(()) int alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number;
111 int alpha_this_literal_sequence_number;
112 int alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number;
113
114 /* Costs of various operations on the different architectures. */
115
116 struct alpha_rtx_cost_data
117 {
118 unsigned char fp_add;
119 unsigned char fp_mult;
120 unsigned char fp_div_sf;
121 unsigned char fp_div_df;
122 unsigned char int_mult_si;
123 unsigned char int_mult_di;
124 unsigned char int_shift;
125 unsigned char int_cmov;
126 unsigned short int_div;
127 };
128
129 static struct alpha_rtx_cost_data const alpha_rtx_cost_data[PROCESSOR_MAX] =
130 {
131 { /* EV4 */
132 COSTS_N_INSNS (6), /* fp_add */
133 COSTS_N_INSNS (6), /* fp_mult */
134 COSTS_N_INSNS (34), /* fp_div_sf */
135 COSTS_N_INSNS (63), /* fp_div_df */
136 COSTS_N_INSNS (23), /* int_mult_si */
137 COSTS_N_INSNS (23), /* int_mult_di */
138 COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_shift */
139 COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_cmov */
140 COSTS_N_INSNS (97), /* int_div */
141 },
142 { /* EV5 */
143 COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_add */
144 COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_mult */
145 COSTS_N_INSNS (15), /* fp_div_sf */
146 COSTS_N_INSNS (22), /* fp_div_df */
147 COSTS_N_INSNS (8), /* int_mult_si */
148 COSTS_N_INSNS (12), /* int_mult_di */
149 COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + 1, /* int_shift */
150 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* int_cmov */
151 COSTS_N_INSNS (83), /* int_div */
152 },
153 { /* EV6 */
154 COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_add */
155 COSTS_N_INSNS (4), /* fp_mult */
156 COSTS_N_INSNS (12), /* fp_div_sf */
157 COSTS_N_INSNS (15), /* fp_div_df */
158 COSTS_N_INSNS (7), /* int_mult_si */
159 COSTS_N_INSNS (7), /* int_mult_di */
160 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* int_shift */
161 COSTS_N_INSNS (2), /* int_cmov */
162 COSTS_N_INSNS (86), /* int_div */
163 },
164 };
165
166 /* Similar but tuned for code size instead of execution latency. The
167 extra +N is fractional cost tuning based on latency. It's used to
168 encourage use of cheaper insns like shift, but only if there's just
169 one of them. */
170
171 static struct alpha_rtx_cost_data const alpha_rtx_cost_size =
172 {
173 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* fp_add */
174 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* fp_mult */
175 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* fp_div_sf */
176 COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + 1, /* fp_div_df */
177 COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + 1, /* int_mult_si */
178 COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + 2, /* int_mult_di */
179 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* int_shift */
180 COSTS_N_INSNS (1), /* int_cmov */
181 COSTS_N_INSNS (6), /* int_div */
182 };
183
184 /* Get the number of args of a function in one of two ways. */
185 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
186 #define NUM_ARGS crtl->args.info.num_args
187 #else
188 #define NUM_ARGS crtl->args.info
189 #endif
190
191 #define REG_PV 27
192 #define REG_RA 26
193
194 /* Declarations of static functions. */
195 static struct machine_function *alpha_init_machine_status (void);
196 static rtx alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (enum rtx_code *, rtx, rtx);
197
198 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
199 static void alpha_write_linkage (FILE *, const char *);
200 static bool vms_valid_pointer_mode (enum machine_mode);
201 #else
202 #define vms_patch_builtins() gcc_unreachable()
203 #endif
204 \f
205 #ifdef TARGET_ALTERNATE_LONG_DOUBLE_MANGLING
206 /* Implement TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE. */
207
208 static const char *
209 alpha_mangle_type (const_tree type)
210 {
211 if (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type) == long_double_type_node
212 && TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE_128)
213 return "g";
214
215 /* For all other types, use normal C++ mangling. */
216 return NULL;
217 }
218 #endif
219
220 /* Parse target option strings. */
221
222 static void
223 alpha_option_override (void)
224 {
225 static const struct cpu_table {
226 const char *const name;
227 const enum processor_type processor;
228 const int flags;
229 } cpu_table[] = {
230 { "ev4", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 },
231 { "ev45", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 },
232 { "21064", PROCESSOR_EV4, 0 },
233 { "ev5", PROCESSOR_EV5, 0 },
234 { "21164", PROCESSOR_EV5, 0 },
235 { "ev56", PROCESSOR_EV5, MASK_BWX },
236 { "21164a", PROCESSOR_EV5, MASK_BWX },
237 { "pca56", PROCESSOR_EV5, MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX },
238 { "21164PC",PROCESSOR_EV5, MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX },
239 { "21164pc",PROCESSOR_EV5, MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX },
240 { "ev6", PROCESSOR_EV6, MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX|MASK_FIX },
241 { "21264", PROCESSOR_EV6, MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX|MASK_FIX },
242 { "ev67", PROCESSOR_EV6, MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX|MASK_FIX|MASK_CIX },
243 { "21264a", PROCESSOR_EV6, MASK_BWX|MASK_MAX|MASK_FIX|MASK_CIX }
244 };
245
246 int const ct_size = ARRAY_SIZE (cpu_table);
247 int i;
248
249 #ifdef SUBTARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
250 SUBTARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS;
251 #endif
252
253 /* Default to full IEEE compliance mode for Go language. */
254 if (strcmp (lang_hooks.name, "GNU Go") == 0
255 && !(target_flags_explicit & MASK_IEEE))
256 target_flags |= MASK_IEEE;
257
258 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM;
259 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG;
260 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_N;
261
262 if (TARGET_IEEE)
263 {
264 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN;
265 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU;
266 }
267 if (TARGET_IEEE_WITH_INEXACT)
268 {
269 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN;
270 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SUI;
271 }
272
273 if (alpha_tp_string)
274 {
275 if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "p"))
276 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG;
277 else if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "f"))
278 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_FUNC;
279 else if (! strcmp (alpha_tp_string, "i"))
280 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN;
281 else
282 error ("bad value %qs for -mtrap-precision switch", alpha_tp_string);
283 }
284
285 if (alpha_fprm_string)
286 {
287 if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "n"))
288 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM;
289 else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "m"))
290 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_MINF;
291 else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string, "c"))
292 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP;
293 else if (! strcmp (alpha_fprm_string,"d"))
294 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_DYN;
295 else
296 error ("bad value %qs for -mfp-rounding-mode switch",
297 alpha_fprm_string);
298 }
299
300 if (alpha_fptm_string)
301 {
302 if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "n") == 0)
303 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_N;
304 else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "u") == 0)
305 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_U;
306 else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "su") == 0)
307 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU;
308 else if (strcmp (alpha_fptm_string, "sui") == 0)
309 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SUI;
310 else
311 error ("bad value %qs for -mfp-trap-mode switch", alpha_fptm_string);
312 }
313
314 if (alpha_cpu_string)
315 {
316 for (i = 0; i < ct_size; i++)
317 if (! strcmp (alpha_cpu_string, cpu_table [i].name))
318 {
319 alpha_tune = alpha_cpu = cpu_table [i].processor;
320 target_flags &= ~ (MASK_BWX | MASK_MAX | MASK_FIX | MASK_CIX);
321 target_flags |= cpu_table [i].flags;
322 break;
323 }
324 if (i == ct_size)
325 error ("bad value %qs for -mcpu switch", alpha_cpu_string);
326 }
327
328 if (alpha_tune_string)
329 {
330 for (i = 0; i < ct_size; i++)
331 if (! strcmp (alpha_tune_string, cpu_table [i].name))
332 {
333 alpha_tune = cpu_table [i].processor;
334 break;
335 }
336 if (i == ct_size)
337 error ("bad value %qs for -mtune switch", alpha_tune_string);
338 }
339
340 /* Do some sanity checks on the above options. */
341
342 if ((alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SU || alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SUI)
343 && alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_INSN && alpha_cpu != PROCESSOR_EV6)
344 {
345 warning (0, "fp software completion requires -mtrap-precision=i");
346 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_INSN;
347 }
348
349 if (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV6)
350 {
351 /* Except for EV6 pass 1 (not released), we always have precise
352 arithmetic traps. Which means we can do software completion
353 without minding trap shadows. */
354 alpha_tp = ALPHA_TP_PROG;
355 }
356
357 if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX)
358 {
359 if (alpha_fprm == ALPHA_FPRM_MINF || alpha_fprm == ALPHA_FPRM_DYN)
360 {
361 warning (0, "rounding mode not supported for VAX floats");
362 alpha_fprm = ALPHA_FPRM_NORM;
363 }
364 if (alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_SUI)
365 {
366 warning (0, "trap mode not supported for VAX floats");
367 alpha_fptm = ALPHA_FPTM_SU;
368 }
369 if (target_flags_explicit & MASK_LONG_DOUBLE_128)
370 warning (0, "128-bit long double not supported for VAX floats");
371 target_flags &= ~MASK_LONG_DOUBLE_128;
372 }
373
374 {
375 char *end;
376 int lat;
377
378 if (!alpha_mlat_string)
379 alpha_mlat_string = "L1";
380
381 if (ISDIGIT ((unsigned char)alpha_mlat_string[0])
382 && (lat = strtol (alpha_mlat_string, &end, 10), *end == '\0'))
383 ;
384 else if ((alpha_mlat_string[0] == 'L' || alpha_mlat_string[0] == 'l')
385 && ISDIGIT ((unsigned char)alpha_mlat_string[1])
386 && alpha_mlat_string[2] == '\0')
387 {
388 static int const cache_latency[][4] =
389 {
390 { 3, 30, -1 }, /* ev4 -- Bcache is a guess */
391 { 2, 12, 38 }, /* ev5 -- Bcache from PC164 LMbench numbers */
392 { 3, 12, 30 }, /* ev6 -- Bcache from DS20 LMbench. */
393 };
394
395 lat = alpha_mlat_string[1] - '0';
396 if (lat <= 0 || lat > 3 || cache_latency[alpha_tune][lat-1] == -1)
397 {
398 warning (0, "L%d cache latency unknown for %s",
399 lat, alpha_cpu_name[alpha_tune]);
400 lat = 3;
401 }
402 else
403 lat = cache_latency[alpha_tune][lat-1];
404 }
405 else if (! strcmp (alpha_mlat_string, "main"))
406 {
407 /* Most current memories have about 370ns latency. This is
408 a reasonable guess for a fast cpu. */
409 lat = 150;
410 }
411 else
412 {
413 warning (0, "bad value %qs for -mmemory-latency", alpha_mlat_string);
414 lat = 3;
415 }
416
417 alpha_memory_latency = lat;
418 }
419
420 /* Default the definition of "small data" to 8 bytes. */
421 if (!global_options_set.x_g_switch_value)
422 g_switch_value = 8;
423
424 /* Infer TARGET_SMALL_DATA from -fpic/-fPIC. */
425 if (flag_pic == 1)
426 target_flags |= MASK_SMALL_DATA;
427 else if (flag_pic == 2)
428 target_flags &= ~MASK_SMALL_DATA;
429
430 /* Align labels and loops for optimal branching. */
431 /* ??? Kludge these by not doing anything if we don't optimize and also if
432 we are writing ECOFF symbols to work around a bug in DEC's assembler. */
433 if (optimize > 0 && write_symbols != SDB_DEBUG)
434 {
435 if (align_loops <= 0)
436 align_loops = 16;
437 if (align_jumps <= 0)
438 align_jumps = 16;
439 }
440 if (align_functions <= 0)
441 align_functions = 16;
442
443 /* Register variables and functions with the garbage collector. */
444
445 /* Set up function hooks. */
446 init_machine_status = alpha_init_machine_status;
447
448 /* Tell the compiler when we're using VAX floating point. */
449 if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX)
450 {
451 REAL_MODE_FORMAT (SFmode) = &vax_f_format;
452 REAL_MODE_FORMAT (DFmode) = &vax_g_format;
453 REAL_MODE_FORMAT (TFmode) = NULL;
454 }
455
456 #ifdef TARGET_DEFAULT_LONG_DOUBLE_128
457 if (!(target_flags_explicit & MASK_LONG_DOUBLE_128))
458 target_flags |= MASK_LONG_DOUBLE_128;
459 #endif
460 }
461 \f
462 /* Returns 1 if VALUE is a mask that contains full bytes of zero or ones. */
463
464 int
465 zap_mask (HOST_WIDE_INT value)
466 {
467 int i;
468
469 for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
470 i++, value >>= 8)
471 if ((value & 0xff) != 0 && (value & 0xff) != 0xff)
472 return 0;
473
474 return 1;
475 }
476
477 /* Return true if OP is valid for a particular TLS relocation.
478 We are already guaranteed that OP is a CONST. */
479
480 int
481 tls_symbolic_operand_1 (rtx op, int size, int unspec)
482 {
483 op = XEXP (op, 0);
484
485 if (GET_CODE (op) != UNSPEC || XINT (op, 1) != unspec)
486 return 0;
487 op = XVECEXP (op, 0, 0);
488
489 if (GET_CODE (op) != SYMBOL_REF)
490 return 0;
491
492 switch (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (op))
493 {
494 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
495 return unspec == UNSPEC_DTPREL && size == alpha_tls_size;
496 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
497 return unspec == UNSPEC_TPREL && size == 64;
498 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
499 return unspec == UNSPEC_TPREL && size == alpha_tls_size;
500 default:
501 gcc_unreachable ();
502 }
503 }
504
505 /* Used by aligned_memory_operand and unaligned_memory_operand to
506 resolve what reload is going to do with OP if it's a register. */
507
508 rtx
509 resolve_reload_operand (rtx op)
510 {
511 if (reload_in_progress)
512 {
513 rtx tmp = op;
514 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SUBREG)
515 tmp = SUBREG_REG (tmp);
516 if (REG_P (tmp)
517 && REGNO (tmp) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
518 {
519 op = reg_equiv_memory_loc (REGNO (tmp));
520 if (op == 0)
521 return 0;
522 }
523 }
524 return op;
525 }
526
527 /* The scalar modes supported differs from the default check-what-c-supports
528 version in that sometimes TFmode is available even when long double
529 indicates only DFmode. */
530
531 static bool
532 alpha_scalar_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode mode)
533 {
534 switch (mode)
535 {
536 case QImode:
537 case HImode:
538 case SImode:
539 case DImode:
540 case TImode: /* via optabs.c */
541 return true;
542
543 case SFmode:
544 case DFmode:
545 return true;
546
547 case TFmode:
548 return TARGET_HAS_XFLOATING_LIBS;
549
550 default:
551 return false;
552 }
553 }
554
555 /* Alpha implements a couple of integer vector mode operations when
556 TARGET_MAX is enabled. We do not check TARGET_MAX here, however,
557 which allows the vectorizer to operate on e.g. move instructions,
558 or when expand_vector_operations can do something useful. */
559
560 static bool
561 alpha_vector_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode mode)
562 {
563 return mode == V8QImode || mode == V4HImode || mode == V2SImode;
564 }
565
566 /* Return 1 if this function can directly return via $26. */
567
568 int
569 direct_return (void)
570 {
571 return (TARGET_ABI_OSF
572 && reload_completed
573 && alpha_sa_size () == 0
574 && get_frame_size () == 0
575 && crtl->outgoing_args_size == 0
576 && crtl->args.pretend_args_size == 0);
577 }
578
579 /* Return the TLS model to use for SYMBOL. */
580
581 static enum tls_model
582 tls_symbolic_operand_type (rtx symbol)
583 {
584 enum tls_model model;
585
586 if (GET_CODE (symbol) != SYMBOL_REF)
587 return TLS_MODEL_NONE;
588 model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (symbol);
589
590 /* Local-exec with a 64-bit size is the same code as initial-exec. */
591 if (model == TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC && alpha_tls_size == 64)
592 model = TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC;
593
594 return model;
595 }
596 \f
597 /* Return true if the function DECL will share the same GP as any
598 function in the current unit of translation. */
599
600 static bool
601 decl_has_samegp (const_tree decl)
602 {
603 /* Functions that are not local can be overridden, and thus may
604 not share the same gp. */
605 if (!(*targetm.binds_local_p) (decl))
606 return false;
607
608 /* If -msmall-data is in effect, assume that there is only one GP
609 for the module, and so any local symbol has this property. We
610 need explicit relocations to be able to enforce this for symbols
611 not defined in this unit of translation, however. */
612 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && TARGET_SMALL_DATA)
613 return true;
614
615 /* Functions that are not external are defined in this UoT. */
616 /* ??? Irritatingly, static functions not yet emitted are still
617 marked "external". Apply this to non-static functions only. */
618 return !TREE_PUBLIC (decl) || !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
619 }
620
621 /* Return true if EXP should be placed in the small data section. */
622
623 static bool
624 alpha_in_small_data_p (const_tree exp)
625 {
626 /* We want to merge strings, so we never consider them small data. */
627 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
628 return false;
629
630 /* Functions are never in the small data area. Duh. */
631 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL)
632 return false;
633
634 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == VAR_DECL && DECL_SECTION_NAME (exp))
635 {
636 const char *section = TREE_STRING_POINTER (DECL_SECTION_NAME (exp));
637 if (strcmp (section, ".sdata") == 0
638 || strcmp (section, ".sbss") == 0)
639 return true;
640 }
641 else
642 {
643 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
644
645 /* If this is an incomplete type with size 0, then we can't put it
646 in sdata because it might be too big when completed. */
647 if (size > 0 && size <= g_switch_value)
648 return true;
649 }
650
651 return false;
652 }
653
654 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
655 static bool
656 vms_valid_pointer_mode (enum machine_mode mode)
657 {
658 return (mode == SImode || mode == DImode);
659 }
660
661 static bool
662 alpha_linkage_symbol_p (const char *symname)
663 {
664 int symlen = strlen (symname);
665
666 if (symlen > 4)
667 return strcmp (&symname [symlen - 4], "..lk") == 0;
668
669 return false;
670 }
671
672 #define LINKAGE_SYMBOL_REF_P(X) \
673 ((GET_CODE (X) == SYMBOL_REF \
674 && alpha_linkage_symbol_p (XSTR (X, 0))) \
675 || (GET_CODE (X) == CONST \
676 && GET_CODE (XEXP (X, 0)) == PLUS \
677 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (X, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF \
678 && alpha_linkage_symbol_p (XSTR (XEXP (XEXP (X, 0), 0), 0))))
679 #endif
680
681 /* legitimate_address_p recognizes an RTL expression that is a valid
682 memory address for an instruction. The MODE argument is the
683 machine mode for the MEM expression that wants to use this address.
684
685 For Alpha, we have either a constant address or the sum of a
686 register and a constant address, or just a register. For DImode,
687 any of those forms can be surrounded with an AND that clear the
688 low-order three bits; this is an "unaligned" access. */
689
690 static bool
691 alpha_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, bool strict)
692 {
693 /* If this is an ldq_u type address, discard the outer AND. */
694 if (mode == DImode
695 && GET_CODE (x) == AND
696 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1))
697 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == -8)
698 x = XEXP (x, 0);
699
700 /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */
701 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
702 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
703 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))))
704 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
705
706 /* Unadorned general registers are valid. */
707 if (REG_P (x)
708 && (strict
709 ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)
710 : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)))
711 return true;
712
713 /* Constant addresses (i.e. +/- 32k) are valid. */
714 if (CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (x))
715 return true;
716
717 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
718 if (LINKAGE_SYMBOL_REF_P (x))
719 return true;
720 #endif
721
722 /* Register plus a small constant offset is valid. */
723 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
724 {
725 rtx ofs = XEXP (x, 1);
726 x = XEXP (x, 0);
727
728 /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */
729 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
730 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
731 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))))
732 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
733
734 if (REG_P (x))
735 {
736 if (! strict
737 && NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FP_BASE_P (x)
738 && CONST_INT_P (ofs))
739 return true;
740 if ((strict
741 ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)
742 : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x))
743 && CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (ofs))
744 return true;
745 }
746 }
747
748 /* If we're managing explicit relocations, LO_SUM is valid, as are small
749 data symbols. Avoid explicit relocations of modes larger than word
750 mode since i.e. $LC0+8($1) can fold around +/- 32k offset. */
751 else if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
752 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
753 {
754 if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
755 return true;
756
757 if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM)
758 {
759 rtx ofs = XEXP (x, 1);
760 x = XEXP (x, 0);
761
762 /* Discard non-paradoxical subregs. */
763 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
764 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
765 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))))
766 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
767
768 /* Must have a valid base register. */
769 if (! (REG_P (x)
770 && (strict
771 ? STRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x)
772 : NONSTRICT_REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (x))))
773 return false;
774
775 /* The symbol must be local. */
776 if (local_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode)
777 || dtp32_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode)
778 || tp32_symbolic_operand (ofs, Pmode))
779 return true;
780 }
781 }
782
783 return false;
784 }
785
786 /* Build the SYMBOL_REF for __tls_get_addr. */
787
788 static GTY(()) rtx tls_get_addr_libfunc;
789
790 static rtx
791 get_tls_get_addr (void)
792 {
793 if (!tls_get_addr_libfunc)
794 tls_get_addr_libfunc = init_one_libfunc ("__tls_get_addr");
795 return tls_get_addr_libfunc;
796 }
797
798 /* Try machine-dependent ways of modifying an illegitimate address
799 to be legitimate. If we find one, return the new, valid address. */
800
801 static rtx
802 alpha_legitimize_address_1 (rtx x, rtx scratch, enum machine_mode mode)
803 {
804 HOST_WIDE_INT addend;
805
806 /* If the address is (plus reg const_int) and the CONST_INT is not a
807 valid offset, compute the high part of the constant and add it to
808 the register. Then our address is (plus temp low-part-const). */
809 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
810 && REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
811 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1))
812 && ! CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
813 {
814 addend = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
815 x = XEXP (x, 0);
816 goto split_addend;
817 }
818
819 /* If the address is (const (plus FOO const_int)), find the low-order
820 part of the CONST_INT. Then load FOO plus any high-order part of the
821 CONST_INT into a register. Our address is (plus reg low-part-const).
822 This is done to reduce the number of GOT entries. */
823 if (can_create_pseudo_p ()
824 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST
825 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
826 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)))
827 {
828 addend = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
829 x = force_reg (Pmode, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
830 goto split_addend;
831 }
832
833 /* If we have a (plus reg const), emit the load as in (2), then add
834 the two registers, and finally generate (plus reg low-part-const) as
835 our address. */
836 if (can_create_pseudo_p ()
837 && GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
838 && REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
839 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST
840 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0)) == PLUS
841 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 1)))
842 {
843 addend = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 1));
844 x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, XEXP (x, 0),
845 XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), 0),
846 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
847 goto split_addend;
848 }
849
850 /* If this is a local symbol, split the address into HIGH/LO_SUM parts.
851 Avoid modes larger than word mode since i.e. $LC0+8($1) can fold
852 around +/- 32k offset. */
853 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
854 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= UNITS_PER_WORD
855 && symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
856 {
857 rtx r0, r16, eqv, tga, tp, insn, dest, seq;
858
859 switch (tls_symbolic_operand_type (x))
860 {
861 case TLS_MODEL_NONE:
862 break;
863
864 case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC:
865 start_sequence ();
866
867 r0 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0);
868 r16 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16);
869 tga = get_tls_get_addr ();
870 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
871 seq = GEN_INT (alpha_next_sequence_number++);
872
873 emit_insn (gen_movdi_er_tlsgd (r16, pic_offset_table_rtx, x, seq));
874 insn = gen_call_value_osf_tlsgd (r0, tga, seq);
875 insn = emit_call_insn (insn);
876 RTL_CONST_CALL_P (insn) = 1;
877 use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn), r16);
878
879 insn = get_insns ();
880 end_sequence ();
881
882 emit_libcall_block (insn, dest, r0, x);
883 return dest;
884
885 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
886 start_sequence ();
887
888 r0 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0);
889 r16 = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16);
890 tga = get_tls_get_addr ();
891 scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
892 seq = GEN_INT (alpha_next_sequence_number++);
893
894 emit_insn (gen_movdi_er_tlsldm (r16, pic_offset_table_rtx, seq));
895 insn = gen_call_value_osf_tlsldm (r0, tga, seq);
896 insn = emit_call_insn (insn);
897 RTL_CONST_CALL_P (insn) = 1;
898 use_reg (&CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn), r16);
899
900 insn = get_insns ();
901 end_sequence ();
902
903 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, const0_rtx),
904 UNSPEC_TLSLDM_CALL);
905 emit_libcall_block (insn, scratch, r0, eqv);
906
907 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_DTPREL);
908 eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv);
909
910 if (alpha_tls_size == 64)
911 {
912 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
913 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, eqv));
914 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (dest, dest, scratch));
915 return dest;
916 }
917 if (alpha_tls_size == 32)
918 {
919 insn = gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, eqv);
920 insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, scratch, insn);
921 scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
922 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch, insn));
923 }
924 return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, scratch, eqv);
925
926 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
927 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_TPREL);
928 eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv);
929 tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
930 scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
931 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
932
933 emit_insn (gen_load_tp (tp));
934 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch, eqv));
935 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (dest, tp, scratch));
936 return dest;
937
938 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
939 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, x), UNSPEC_TPREL);
940 eqv = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, eqv);
941 tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
942
943 emit_insn (gen_load_tp (tp));
944 if (alpha_tls_size == 32)
945 {
946 insn = gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, eqv);
947 insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, insn);
948 tp = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
949 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tp, insn));
950 }
951 return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, tp, eqv);
952
953 default:
954 gcc_unreachable ();
955 }
956
957 if (local_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
958 {
959 if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
960 return x;
961 else
962 {
963 if (can_create_pseudo_p ())
964 scratch = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
965 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch,
966 gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, x)));
967 return gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, scratch, x);
968 }
969 }
970 }
971
972 return NULL;
973
974 split_addend:
975 {
976 HOST_WIDE_INT low, high;
977
978 low = ((addend & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
979 addend -= low;
980 high = ((addend & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
981 addend -= high;
982
983 if (addend)
984 x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, x, GEN_INT (addend),
985 (!can_create_pseudo_p () ? scratch : NULL_RTX),
986 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
987 if (high)
988 x = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, x, GEN_INT (high),
989 (!can_create_pseudo_p () ? scratch : NULL_RTX),
990 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
991
992 return plus_constant (x, low);
993 }
994 }
995
996
997 /* Try machine-dependent ways of modifying an illegitimate address
998 to be legitimate. Return X or the new, valid address. */
999
1000 static rtx
1001 alpha_legitimize_address (rtx x, rtx oldx ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1002 enum machine_mode mode)
1003 {
1004 rtx new_x = alpha_legitimize_address_1 (x, NULL_RTX, mode);
1005 return new_x ? new_x : x;
1006 }
1007
1008 /* Primarily this is required for TLS symbols, but given that our move
1009 patterns *ought* to be able to handle any symbol at any time, we
1010 should never be spilling symbolic operands to the constant pool, ever. */
1011
1012 static bool
1013 alpha_cannot_force_const_mem (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx x)
1014 {
1015 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
1016 return code == SYMBOL_REF || code == LABEL_REF || code == CONST;
1017 }
1018
1019 /* We do not allow indirect calls to be optimized into sibling calls, nor
1020 can we allow a call to a function with a different GP to be optimized
1021 into a sibcall. */
1022
1023 static bool
1024 alpha_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl, tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1025 {
1026 /* Can't do indirect tail calls, since we don't know if the target
1027 uses the same GP. */
1028 if (!decl)
1029 return false;
1030
1031 /* Otherwise, we can make a tail call if the target function shares
1032 the same GP. */
1033 return decl_has_samegp (decl);
1034 }
1035
1036 int
1037 some_small_symbolic_operand_int (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1038 {
1039 rtx x = *px;
1040
1041 /* Don't re-split. */
1042 if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM)
1043 return -1;
1044
1045 return small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode) != 0;
1046 }
1047
1048 static int
1049 split_small_symbolic_operand_1 (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1050 {
1051 rtx x = *px;
1052
1053 /* Don't re-split. */
1054 if (GET_CODE (x) == LO_SUM)
1055 return -1;
1056
1057 if (small_symbolic_operand (x, Pmode))
1058 {
1059 x = gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode, pic_offset_table_rtx, x);
1060 *px = x;
1061 return -1;
1062 }
1063
1064 return 0;
1065 }
1066
1067 rtx
1068 split_small_symbolic_operand (rtx x)
1069 {
1070 x = copy_insn (x);
1071 for_each_rtx (&x, split_small_symbolic_operand_1, NULL);
1072 return x;
1073 }
1074
1075 /* Indicate that INSN cannot be duplicated. This is true for any insn
1076 that we've marked with gpdisp relocs, since those have to stay in
1077 1-1 correspondence with one another.
1078
1079 Technically we could copy them if we could set up a mapping from one
1080 sequence number to another, across the set of insns to be duplicated.
1081 This seems overly complicated and error-prone since interblock motion
1082 from sched-ebb could move one of the pair of insns to a different block.
1083
1084 Also cannot allow jsr insns to be duplicated. If they throw exceptions,
1085 then they'll be in a different block from their ldgp. Which could lead
1086 the bb reorder code to think that it would be ok to copy just the block
1087 containing the call and branch to the block containing the ldgp. */
1088
1089 static bool
1090 alpha_cannot_copy_insn_p (rtx insn)
1091 {
1092 if (!reload_completed || !TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
1093 return false;
1094 if (recog_memoized (insn) >= 0)
1095 return get_attr_cannot_copy (insn);
1096 else
1097 return false;
1098 }
1099
1100
1101 /* Try a machine-dependent way of reloading an illegitimate address
1102 operand. If we find one, push the reload and return the new rtx. */
1103
1104 rtx
1105 alpha_legitimize_reload_address (rtx x,
1106 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1107 int opnum, int type,
1108 int ind_levels ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1109 {
1110 /* We must recognize output that we have already generated ourselves. */
1111 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
1112 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
1113 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
1114 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))
1115 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
1116 {
1117 push_reload (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, &XEXP (x, 0), NULL,
1118 BASE_REG_CLASS, GET_MODE (x), VOIDmode, 0, 0,
1119 opnum, (enum reload_type) type);
1120 return x;
1121 }
1122
1123 /* We wish to handle large displacements off a base register by
1124 splitting the addend across an ldah and the mem insn. This
1125 cuts number of extra insns needed from 3 to 1. */
1126 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
1127 && REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
1128 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1129 && REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)))
1130 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1131 {
1132 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
1133 HOST_WIDE_INT low = ((val & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1134 HOST_WIDE_INT high
1135 = (((val - low) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
1136
1137 /* Check for 32-bit overflow. */
1138 if (high + low != val)
1139 return NULL_RTX;
1140
1141 /* Reload the high part into a base reg; leave the low part
1142 in the mem directly. */
1143 x = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x),
1144 gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
1145 GEN_INT (high)),
1146 GEN_INT (low));
1147
1148 push_reload (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX, &XEXP (x, 0), NULL,
1149 BASE_REG_CLASS, GET_MODE (x), VOIDmode, 0, 0,
1150 opnum, (enum reload_type) type);
1151 return x;
1152 }
1153
1154 return NULL_RTX;
1155 }
1156 \f
1157 /* Compute a (partial) cost for rtx X. Return true if the complete
1158 cost has been computed, and false if subexpressions should be
1159 scanned. In either case, *TOTAL contains the cost result. */
1160
1161 static bool
1162 alpha_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int opno, int *total,
1163 bool speed)
1164 {
1165 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
1166 bool float_mode_p = FLOAT_MODE_P (mode);
1167 const struct alpha_rtx_cost_data *cost_data;
1168
1169 if (!speed)
1170 cost_data = &alpha_rtx_cost_size;
1171 else
1172 cost_data = &alpha_rtx_cost_data[alpha_tune];
1173
1174 switch (code)
1175 {
1176 case CONST_INT:
1177 /* If this is an 8-bit constant, return zero since it can be used
1178 nearly anywhere with no cost. If it is a valid operand for an
1179 ADD or AND, likewise return 0 if we know it will be used in that
1180 context. Otherwise, return 2 since it might be used there later.
1181 All other constants take at least two insns. */
1182 if (INTVAL (x) >= 0 && INTVAL (x) < 256)
1183 {
1184 *total = 0;
1185 return true;
1186 }
1187 /* FALLTHRU */
1188
1189 case CONST_DOUBLE:
1190 if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
1191 *total = 0;
1192 else if ((outer_code == PLUS && add_operand (x, VOIDmode))
1193 || (outer_code == AND && and_operand (x, VOIDmode)))
1194 *total = 0;
1195 else if (add_operand (x, VOIDmode) || and_operand (x, VOIDmode))
1196 *total = 2;
1197 else
1198 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
1199 return true;
1200
1201 case CONST:
1202 case SYMBOL_REF:
1203 case LABEL_REF:
1204 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && small_symbolic_operand (x, VOIDmode))
1205 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (outer_code != MEM);
1206 else if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS && local_symbolic_operand (x, VOIDmode))
1207 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1 + (outer_code != MEM));
1208 else if (tls_symbolic_operand_type (x))
1209 /* Estimate of cost for call_pal rduniq. */
1210 /* ??? How many insns do we emit here? More than one... */
1211 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (15);
1212 else
1213 /* Otherwise we do a load from the GOT. */
1214 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (!speed ? 1 : alpha_memory_latency);
1215 return true;
1216
1217 case HIGH:
1218 /* This is effectively an add_operand. */
1219 *total = 2;
1220 return true;
1221
1222 case PLUS:
1223 case MINUS:
1224 if (float_mode_p)
1225 *total = cost_data->fp_add;
1226 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT
1227 && const48_operand (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1), VOIDmode))
1228 {
1229 *total = (rtx_cost (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0),
1230 (enum rtx_code) outer_code, opno, speed)
1231 + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 1),
1232 (enum rtx_code) outer_code, opno, speed)
1233 + COSTS_N_INSNS (1));
1234 return true;
1235 }
1236 return false;
1237
1238 case MULT:
1239 if (float_mode_p)
1240 *total = cost_data->fp_mult;
1241 else if (mode == DImode)
1242 *total = cost_data->int_mult_di;
1243 else
1244 *total = cost_data->int_mult_si;
1245 return false;
1246
1247 case ASHIFT:
1248 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (x, 1))
1249 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) <= 3)
1250 {
1251 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
1252 return false;
1253 }
1254 /* FALLTHRU */
1255
1256 case ASHIFTRT:
1257 case LSHIFTRT:
1258 *total = cost_data->int_shift;
1259 return false;
1260
1261 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
1262 if (float_mode_p)
1263 *total = cost_data->fp_add;
1264 else
1265 *total = cost_data->int_cmov;
1266 return false;
1267
1268 case DIV:
1269 case UDIV:
1270 case MOD:
1271 case UMOD:
1272 if (!float_mode_p)
1273 *total = cost_data->int_div;
1274 else if (mode == SFmode)
1275 *total = cost_data->fp_div_sf;
1276 else
1277 *total = cost_data->fp_div_df;
1278 return false;
1279
1280 case MEM:
1281 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (!speed ? 1 : alpha_memory_latency);
1282 return true;
1283
1284 case NEG:
1285 if (! float_mode_p)
1286 {
1287 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
1288 return false;
1289 }
1290 /* FALLTHRU */
1291
1292 case ABS:
1293 if (! float_mode_p)
1294 {
1295 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + cost_data->int_cmov;
1296 return false;
1297 }
1298 /* FALLTHRU */
1299
1300 case FLOAT:
1301 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
1302 case FIX:
1303 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
1304 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
1305 *total = cost_data->fp_add;
1306 return false;
1307
1308 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
1309 if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
1310 *total = 0;
1311 else
1312 *total = cost_data->fp_add;
1313 return false;
1314
1315 default:
1316 return false;
1317 }
1318 }
1319 \f
1320 /* REF is an alignable memory location. Place an aligned SImode
1321 reference into *PALIGNED_MEM and the number of bits to shift into
1322 *PBITNUM. SCRATCH is a free register for use in reloading out
1323 of range stack slots. */
1324
1325 void
1326 get_aligned_mem (rtx ref, rtx *paligned_mem, rtx *pbitnum)
1327 {
1328 rtx base;
1329 HOST_WIDE_INT disp, offset;
1330
1331 gcc_assert (MEM_P (ref));
1332
1333 if (reload_in_progress
1334 && ! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), XEXP (ref, 0)))
1335 {
1336 base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0));
1337 gcc_assert (memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), base));
1338 }
1339 else
1340 base = XEXP (ref, 0);
1341
1342 if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS)
1343 disp = INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1)), base = XEXP (base, 0);
1344 else
1345 disp = 0;
1346
1347 /* Find the byte offset within an aligned word. If the memory itself is
1348 claimed to be aligned, believe it. Otherwise, aligned_memory_operand
1349 will have examined the base register and determined it is aligned, and
1350 thus displacements from it are naturally alignable. */
1351 if (MEM_ALIGN (ref) >= 32)
1352 offset = 0;
1353 else
1354 offset = disp & 3;
1355
1356 /* The location should not cross aligned word boundary. */
1357 gcc_assert (offset + GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (ref))
1358 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (SImode));
1359
1360 /* Access the entire aligned word. */
1361 *paligned_mem = widen_memory_access (ref, SImode, -offset);
1362
1363 /* Convert the byte offset within the word to a bit offset. */
1364 offset *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
1365 *pbitnum = GEN_INT (offset);
1366 }
1367
1368 /* Similar, but just get the address. Handle the two reload cases.
1369 Add EXTRA_OFFSET to the address we return. */
1370
1371 rtx
1372 get_unaligned_address (rtx ref)
1373 {
1374 rtx base;
1375 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1376
1377 gcc_assert (MEM_P (ref));
1378
1379 if (reload_in_progress
1380 && ! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), XEXP (ref, 0)))
1381 {
1382 base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0));
1383
1384 gcc_assert (memory_address_p (GET_MODE (ref), base));
1385 }
1386 else
1387 base = XEXP (ref, 0);
1388
1389 if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS)
1390 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1)), base = XEXP (base, 0);
1391
1392 return plus_constant (base, offset);
1393 }
1394
1395 /* Compute a value X, such that X & 7 == (ADDR + OFS) & 7.
1396 X is always returned in a register. */
1397
1398 rtx
1399 get_unaligned_offset (rtx addr, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs)
1400 {
1401 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS)
1402 {
1403 ofs += INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1));
1404 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
1405 }
1406
1407 return expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, addr, GEN_INT (ofs & 7),
1408 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1409 }
1410
1411 /* On the Alpha, all (non-symbolic) constants except zero go into
1412 a floating-point register via memory. Note that we cannot
1413 return anything that is not a subset of RCLASS, and that some
1414 symbolic constants cannot be dropped to memory. */
1415
1416 enum reg_class
1417 alpha_preferred_reload_class(rtx x, enum reg_class rclass)
1418 {
1419 /* Zero is present in any register class. */
1420 if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)))
1421 return rclass;
1422
1423 /* These sorts of constants we can easily drop to memory. */
1424 if (CONST_INT_P (x)
1425 || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
1426 || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_VECTOR)
1427 {
1428 if (rclass == FLOAT_REGS)
1429 return NO_REGS;
1430 if (rclass == ALL_REGS)
1431 return GENERAL_REGS;
1432 return rclass;
1433 }
1434
1435 /* All other kinds of constants should not (and in the case of HIGH
1436 cannot) be dropped to memory -- instead we use a GENERAL_REGS
1437 secondary reload. */
1438 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
1439 return (rclass == ALL_REGS ? GENERAL_REGS : rclass);
1440
1441 return rclass;
1442 }
1443
1444 /* Inform reload about cases where moving X with a mode MODE to a register in
1445 RCLASS requires an extra scratch or immediate register. Return the class
1446 needed for the immediate register. */
1447
1448 static reg_class_t
1449 alpha_secondary_reload (bool in_p, rtx x, reg_class_t rclass_i,
1450 enum machine_mode mode, secondary_reload_info *sri)
1451 {
1452 enum reg_class rclass = (enum reg_class) rclass_i;
1453
1454 /* Loading and storing HImode or QImode values to and from memory
1455 usually requires a scratch register. */
1456 if (!TARGET_BWX && (mode == QImode || mode == HImode || mode == CQImode))
1457 {
1458 if (any_memory_operand (x, mode))
1459 {
1460 if (in_p)
1461 {
1462 if (!aligned_memory_operand (x, mode))
1463 sri->icode = direct_optab_handler (reload_in_optab, mode);
1464 }
1465 else
1466 sri->icode = direct_optab_handler (reload_out_optab, mode);
1467 return NO_REGS;
1468 }
1469 }
1470
1471 /* We also cannot do integral arithmetic into FP regs, as might result
1472 from register elimination into a DImode fp register. */
1473 if (rclass == FLOAT_REGS)
1474 {
1475 if (MEM_P (x) && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == AND)
1476 return GENERAL_REGS;
1477 if (in_p && INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode)
1478 && !MEM_P (x) && !REG_P (x) && !CONST_INT_P (x))
1479 return GENERAL_REGS;
1480 }
1481
1482 return NO_REGS;
1483 }
1484 \f
1485 /* Subfunction of the following function. Update the flags of any MEM
1486 found in part of X. */
1487
1488 static int
1489 alpha_set_memflags_1 (rtx *xp, void *data)
1490 {
1491 rtx x = *xp, orig = (rtx) data;
1492
1493 if (!MEM_P (x))
1494 return 0;
1495
1496 MEM_VOLATILE_P (x) = MEM_VOLATILE_P (orig);
1497 MEM_NOTRAP_P (x) = MEM_NOTRAP_P (orig);
1498 MEM_READONLY_P (x) = MEM_READONLY_P (orig);
1499
1500 /* Sadly, we cannot use alias sets because the extra aliasing
1501 produced by the AND interferes. Given that two-byte quantities
1502 are the only thing we would be able to differentiate anyway,
1503 there does not seem to be any point in convoluting the early
1504 out of the alias check. */
1505
1506 return -1;
1507 }
1508
1509 /* Given SEQ, which is an INSN list, look for any MEMs in either
1510 a SET_DEST or a SET_SRC and copy the in-struct, unchanging, and
1511 volatile flags from REF into each of the MEMs found. If REF is not
1512 a MEM, don't do anything. */
1513
1514 void
1515 alpha_set_memflags (rtx seq, rtx ref)
1516 {
1517 rtx insn;
1518
1519 if (!MEM_P (ref))
1520 return;
1521
1522 /* This is only called from alpha.md, after having had something
1523 generated from one of the insn patterns. So if everything is
1524 zero, the pattern is already up-to-date. */
1525 if (!MEM_VOLATILE_P (ref)
1526 && !MEM_NOTRAP_P (ref)
1527 && !MEM_READONLY_P (ref))
1528 return;
1529
1530 for (insn = seq; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1531 if (INSN_P (insn))
1532 for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), alpha_set_memflags_1, (void *) ref);
1533 else
1534 gcc_unreachable ();
1535 }
1536 \f
1537 static rtx alpha_emit_set_const (rtx, enum machine_mode, HOST_WIDE_INT,
1538 int, bool);
1539
1540 /* Internal routine for alpha_emit_set_const to check for N or below insns.
1541 If NO_OUTPUT is true, then we only check to see if N insns are possible,
1542 and return pc_rtx if successful. */
1543
1544 static rtx
1545 alpha_emit_set_const_1 (rtx target, enum machine_mode mode,
1546 HOST_WIDE_INT c, int n, bool no_output)
1547 {
1548 HOST_WIDE_INT new_const;
1549 int i, bits;
1550 /* Use a pseudo if highly optimizing and still generating RTL. */
1551 rtx subtarget
1552 = (flag_expensive_optimizations && can_create_pseudo_p () ? 0 : target);
1553 rtx temp, insn;
1554
1555 /* If this is a sign-extended 32-bit constant, we can do this in at most
1556 three insns, so do it if we have enough insns left. We always have
1557 a sign-extended 32-bit constant when compiling on a narrow machine. */
1558
1559 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT != 64
1560 || c >> 31 == -1 || c >> 31 == 0)
1561 {
1562 HOST_WIDE_INT low = ((c & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1563 HOST_WIDE_INT tmp1 = c - low;
1564 HOST_WIDE_INT high = (((tmp1 >> 16) & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1565 HOST_WIDE_INT extra = 0;
1566
1567 /* If HIGH will be interpreted as negative but the constant is
1568 positive, we must adjust it to do two ldha insns. */
1569
1570 if ((high & 0x8000) != 0 && c >= 0)
1571 {
1572 extra = 0x4000;
1573 tmp1 -= 0x40000000;
1574 high = ((tmp1 >> 16) & 0xffff) - 2 * ((tmp1 >> 16) & 0x8000);
1575 }
1576
1577 if (c == low || (low == 0 && extra == 0))
1578 {
1579 /* We used to use copy_to_suggested_reg (GEN_INT (c), target, mode)
1580 but that meant that we can't handle INT_MIN on 32-bit machines
1581 (like NT/Alpha), because we recurse indefinitely through
1582 emit_move_insn to gen_movdi. So instead, since we know exactly
1583 what we want, create it explicitly. */
1584
1585 if (no_output)
1586 return pc_rtx;
1587 if (target == NULL)
1588 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1589 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, GEN_INT (c)));
1590 return target;
1591 }
1592 else if (n >= 2 + (extra != 0))
1593 {
1594 if (no_output)
1595 return pc_rtx;
1596 if (!can_create_pseudo_p ())
1597 {
1598 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, GEN_INT (high << 16)));
1599 temp = target;
1600 }
1601 else
1602 temp = copy_to_suggested_reg (GEN_INT (high << 16),
1603 subtarget, mode);
1604
1605 /* As of 2002-02-23, addsi3 is only available when not optimizing.
1606 This means that if we go through expand_binop, we'll try to
1607 generate extensions, etc, which will require new pseudos, which
1608 will fail during some split phases. The SImode add patterns
1609 still exist, but are not named. So build the insns by hand. */
1610
1611 if (extra != 0)
1612 {
1613 if (! subtarget)
1614 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1615 insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, temp, GEN_INT (extra << 16));
1616 insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, subtarget, insn);
1617 emit_insn (insn);
1618 temp = subtarget;
1619 }
1620
1621 if (target == NULL)
1622 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1623 insn = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, temp, GEN_INT (low));
1624 insn = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, insn);
1625 emit_insn (insn);
1626 return target;
1627 }
1628 }
1629
1630 /* If we couldn't do it that way, try some other methods. But if we have
1631 no instructions left, don't bother. Likewise, if this is SImode and
1632 we can't make pseudos, we can't do anything since the expand_binop
1633 and expand_unop calls will widen and try to make pseudos. */
1634
1635 if (n == 1 || (mode == SImode && !can_create_pseudo_p ()))
1636 return 0;
1637
1638 /* Next, see if we can load a related constant and then shift and possibly
1639 negate it to get the constant we want. Try this once each increasing
1640 numbers of insns. */
1641
1642 for (i = 1; i < n; i++)
1643 {
1644 /* First, see if minus some low bits, we've an easy load of
1645 high bits. */
1646
1647 new_const = ((c & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1648 if (new_const != 0)
1649 {
1650 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, c - new_const, i, no_output);
1651 if (temp)
1652 {
1653 if (no_output)
1654 return temp;
1655 return expand_binop (mode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (new_const),
1656 target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
1657 }
1658 }
1659
1660 /* Next try complementing. */
1661 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, ~c, i, no_output);
1662 if (temp)
1663 {
1664 if (no_output)
1665 return temp;
1666 return expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, temp, target, 0);
1667 }
1668
1669 /* Next try to form a constant and do a left shift. We can do this
1670 if some low-order bits are zero; the exact_log2 call below tells
1671 us that information. The bits we are shifting out could be any
1672 value, but here we'll just try the 0- and sign-extended forms of
1673 the constant. To try to increase the chance of having the same
1674 constant in more than one insn, start at the highest number of
1675 bits to shift, but try all possibilities in case a ZAPNOT will
1676 be useful. */
1677
1678 bits = exact_log2 (c & -c);
1679 if (bits > 0)
1680 for (; bits > 0; bits--)
1681 {
1682 new_const = c >> bits;
1683 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new_const, i, no_output);
1684 if (!temp && c < 0)
1685 {
1686 new_const = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)c >> bits;
1687 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new_const,
1688 i, no_output);
1689 }
1690 if (temp)
1691 {
1692 if (no_output)
1693 return temp;
1694 return expand_binop (mode, ashl_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits),
1695 target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
1696 }
1697 }
1698
1699 /* Now try high-order zero bits. Here we try the shifted-in bits as
1700 all zero and all ones. Be careful to avoid shifting outside the
1701 mode and to avoid shifting outside the host wide int size. */
1702 /* On narrow hosts, don't shift a 1 into the high bit, since we'll
1703 confuse the recursive call and set all of the high 32 bits. */
1704
1705 bits = (MIN (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) * 8)
1706 - floor_log2 (c) - 1 - (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT < 64));
1707 if (bits > 0)
1708 for (; bits > 0; bits--)
1709 {
1710 new_const = c << bits;
1711 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new_const, i, no_output);
1712 if (!temp)
1713 {
1714 new_const = (c << bits) | (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bits) - 1);
1715 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new_const,
1716 i, no_output);
1717 }
1718 if (temp)
1719 {
1720 if (no_output)
1721 return temp;
1722 return expand_binop (mode, lshr_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits),
1723 target, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
1724 }
1725 }
1726
1727 /* Now try high-order 1 bits. We get that with a sign-extension.
1728 But one bit isn't enough here. Be careful to avoid shifting outside
1729 the mode and to avoid shifting outside the host wide int size. */
1730
1731 bits = (MIN (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) * 8)
1732 - floor_log2 (~ c) - 2);
1733 if (bits > 0)
1734 for (; bits > 0; bits--)
1735 {
1736 new_const = c << bits;
1737 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new_const, i, no_output);
1738 if (!temp)
1739 {
1740 new_const = (c << bits) | (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bits) - 1);
1741 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new_const,
1742 i, no_output);
1743 }
1744 if (temp)
1745 {
1746 if (no_output)
1747 return temp;
1748 return expand_binop (mode, ashr_optab, temp, GEN_INT (bits),
1749 target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
1750 }
1751 }
1752 }
1753
1754 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
1755 /* Finally, see if can load a value into the target that is the same as the
1756 constant except that all bytes that are 0 are changed to be 0xff. If we
1757 can, then we can do a ZAPNOT to obtain the desired constant. */
1758
1759 new_const = c;
1760 for (i = 0; i < 64; i += 8)
1761 if ((new_const & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff << i)) == 0)
1762 new_const |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff << i;
1763
1764 /* We are only called for SImode and DImode. If this is SImode, ensure that
1765 we are sign extended to a full word. */
1766
1767 if (mode == SImode)
1768 new_const = ((new_const & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
1769
1770 if (new_const != c)
1771 {
1772 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (subtarget, mode, new_const, n - 1, no_output);
1773 if (temp)
1774 {
1775 if (no_output)
1776 return temp;
1777 return expand_binop (mode, and_optab, temp, GEN_INT (c | ~ new_const),
1778 target, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
1779 }
1780 }
1781 #endif
1782
1783 return 0;
1784 }
1785
1786 /* Try to output insns to set TARGET equal to the constant C if it can be
1787 done in less than N insns. Do all computations in MODE. Returns the place
1788 where the output has been placed if it can be done and the insns have been
1789 emitted. If it would take more than N insns, zero is returned and no
1790 insns and emitted. */
1791
1792 static rtx
1793 alpha_emit_set_const (rtx target, enum machine_mode mode,
1794 HOST_WIDE_INT c, int n, bool no_output)
1795 {
1796 enum machine_mode orig_mode = mode;
1797 rtx orig_target = target;
1798 rtx result = 0;
1799 int i;
1800
1801 /* If we can't make any pseudos, TARGET is an SImode hard register, we
1802 can't load this constant in one insn, do this in DImode. */
1803 if (!can_create_pseudo_p () && mode == SImode
1804 && REG_P (target) && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1805 {
1806 result = alpha_emit_set_const_1 (target, mode, c, 1, no_output);
1807 if (result)
1808 return result;
1809
1810 target = no_output ? NULL : gen_lowpart (DImode, target);
1811 mode = DImode;
1812 }
1813 else if (mode == V8QImode || mode == V4HImode || mode == V2SImode)
1814 {
1815 target = no_output ? NULL : gen_lowpart (DImode, target);
1816 mode = DImode;
1817 }
1818
1819 /* Try 1 insn, then 2, then up to N. */
1820 for (i = 1; i <= n; i++)
1821 {
1822 result = alpha_emit_set_const_1 (target, mode, c, i, no_output);
1823 if (result)
1824 {
1825 rtx insn, set;
1826
1827 if (no_output)
1828 return result;
1829
1830 insn = get_last_insn ();
1831 set = single_set (insn);
1832 if (! CONSTANT_P (SET_SRC (set)))
1833 set_unique_reg_note (get_last_insn (), REG_EQUAL, GEN_INT (c));
1834 break;
1835 }
1836 }
1837
1838 /* Allow for the case where we changed the mode of TARGET. */
1839 if (result)
1840 {
1841 if (result == target)
1842 result = orig_target;
1843 else if (mode != orig_mode)
1844 result = gen_lowpart (orig_mode, result);
1845 }
1846
1847 return result;
1848 }
1849
1850 /* Having failed to find a 3 insn sequence in alpha_emit_set_const,
1851 fall back to a straight forward decomposition. We do this to avoid
1852 exponential run times encountered when looking for longer sequences
1853 with alpha_emit_set_const. */
1854
1855 static rtx
1856 alpha_emit_set_long_const (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT c1, HOST_WIDE_INT c2)
1857 {
1858 HOST_WIDE_INT d1, d2, d3, d4;
1859
1860 /* Decompose the entire word */
1861 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
1862 gcc_assert (c2 == -(c1 < 0));
1863 d1 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1864 c1 -= d1;
1865 d2 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
1866 c1 = (c1 - d2) >> 32;
1867 d3 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1868 c1 -= d3;
1869 d4 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
1870 gcc_assert (c1 == d4);
1871 #else
1872 d1 = ((c1 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1873 c1 -= d1;
1874 d2 = ((c1 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
1875 gcc_assert (c1 == d2);
1876 c2 += (d2 < 0);
1877 d3 = ((c2 & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
1878 c2 -= d3;
1879 d4 = ((c2 & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
1880 gcc_assert (c2 == d4);
1881 #endif
1882
1883 /* Construct the high word */
1884 if (d4)
1885 {
1886 emit_move_insn (target, GEN_INT (d4));
1887 if (d3)
1888 emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d3)));
1889 }
1890 else
1891 emit_move_insn (target, GEN_INT (d3));
1892
1893 /* Shift it into place */
1894 emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_ASHIFT (DImode, target, GEN_INT (32)));
1895
1896 /* Add in the low bits. */
1897 if (d2)
1898 emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d2)));
1899 if (d1)
1900 emit_move_insn (target, gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, target, GEN_INT (d1)));
1901
1902 return target;
1903 }
1904
1905 /* Given an integral CONST_INT, CONST_DOUBLE, or CONST_VECTOR, return
1906 the low 64 bits. */
1907
1908 static void
1909 alpha_extract_integer (rtx x, HOST_WIDE_INT *p0, HOST_WIDE_INT *p1)
1910 {
1911 HOST_WIDE_INT i0, i1;
1912
1913 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_VECTOR)
1914 x = simplify_subreg (DImode, x, GET_MODE (x), 0);
1915
1916
1917 if (CONST_INT_P (x))
1918 {
1919 i0 = INTVAL (x);
1920 i1 = -(i0 < 0);
1921 }
1922 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
1923 {
1924 i0 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x);
1925 i1 = -(i0 < 0);
1926 }
1927 else
1928 {
1929 i0 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x);
1930 i1 = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (x);
1931 }
1932
1933 *p0 = i0;
1934 *p1 = i1;
1935 }
1936
1937 /* Implement TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P. This is all constants for which
1938 we are willing to load the value into a register via a move pattern.
1939 Normally this is all symbolic constants, integral constants that
1940 take three or fewer instructions, and floating-point zero. */
1941
1942 bool
1943 alpha_legitimate_constant_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
1944 {
1945 HOST_WIDE_INT i0, i1;
1946
1947 switch (GET_CODE (x))
1948 {
1949 case LABEL_REF:
1950 case HIGH:
1951 return true;
1952
1953 case CONST:
1954 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
1955 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
1956 x = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
1957 else
1958 return true;
1959
1960 if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
1961 return true;
1962
1963 /* FALLTHRU */
1964
1965 case SYMBOL_REF:
1966 /* TLS symbols are never valid. */
1967 return SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x) == 0;
1968
1969 case CONST_DOUBLE:
1970 if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
1971 return true;
1972 if (FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
1973 return false;
1974 goto do_integer;
1975
1976 case CONST_VECTOR:
1977 if (x == CONST0_RTX (mode))
1978 return true;
1979 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_VECTOR_INT)
1980 return false;
1981 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 8)
1982 return false;
1983 goto do_integer;
1984
1985 case CONST_INT:
1986 do_integer:
1987 if (TARGET_BUILD_CONSTANTS)
1988 return true;
1989 alpha_extract_integer (x, &i0, &i1);
1990 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64 || i1 == (-i0 < 0))
1991 return alpha_emit_set_const_1 (x, mode, i0, 3, true) != NULL;
1992 return false;
1993
1994 default:
1995 return false;
1996 }
1997 }
1998
1999 /* Operand 1 is known to be a constant, and should require more than one
2000 instruction to load. Emit that multi-part load. */
2001
2002 bool
2003 alpha_split_const_mov (enum machine_mode mode, rtx *operands)
2004 {
2005 HOST_WIDE_INT i0, i1;
2006 rtx temp = NULL_RTX;
2007
2008 alpha_extract_integer (operands[1], &i0, &i1);
2009
2010 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64 || i1 == -(i0 < 0))
2011 temp = alpha_emit_set_const (operands[0], mode, i0, 3, false);
2012
2013 if (!temp && TARGET_BUILD_CONSTANTS)
2014 temp = alpha_emit_set_long_const (operands[0], i0, i1);
2015
2016 if (temp)
2017 {
2018 if (!rtx_equal_p (operands[0], temp))
2019 emit_move_insn (operands[0], temp);
2020 return true;
2021 }
2022
2023 return false;
2024 }
2025
2026 /* Expand a move instruction; return true if all work is done.
2027 We don't handle non-bwx subword loads here. */
2028
2029 bool
2030 alpha_expand_mov (enum machine_mode mode, rtx *operands)
2031 {
2032 rtx tmp;
2033
2034 /* If the output is not a register, the input must be. */
2035 if (MEM_P (operands[0])
2036 && ! reg_or_0_operand (operands[1], mode))
2037 operands[1] = force_reg (mode, operands[1]);
2038
2039 /* Allow legitimize_address to perform some simplifications. */
2040 if (mode == Pmode && symbolic_operand (operands[1], mode))
2041 {
2042 tmp = alpha_legitimize_address_1 (operands[1], operands[0], mode);
2043 if (tmp)
2044 {
2045 if (tmp == operands[0])
2046 return true;
2047 operands[1] = tmp;
2048 return false;
2049 }
2050 }
2051
2052 /* Early out for non-constants and valid constants. */
2053 if (! CONSTANT_P (operands[1]) || input_operand (operands[1], mode))
2054 return false;
2055
2056 /* Split large integers. */
2057 if (CONST_INT_P (operands[1])
2058 || GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_DOUBLE
2059 || GET_CODE (operands[1]) == CONST_VECTOR)
2060 {
2061 if (alpha_split_const_mov (mode, operands))
2062 return true;
2063 }
2064
2065 /* Otherwise we've nothing left but to drop the thing to memory. */
2066 tmp = force_const_mem (mode, operands[1]);
2067
2068 if (tmp == NULL_RTX)
2069 return false;
2070
2071 if (reload_in_progress)
2072 {
2073 emit_move_insn (operands[0], XEXP (tmp, 0));
2074 operands[1] = replace_equiv_address (tmp, operands[0]);
2075 }
2076 else
2077 operands[1] = validize_mem (tmp);
2078 return false;
2079 }
2080
2081 /* Expand a non-bwx QImode or HImode move instruction;
2082 return true if all work is done. */
2083
2084 bool
2085 alpha_expand_mov_nobwx (enum machine_mode mode, rtx *operands)
2086 {
2087 rtx seq;
2088
2089 /* If the output is not a register, the input must be. */
2090 if (MEM_P (operands[0]))
2091 operands[1] = force_reg (mode, operands[1]);
2092
2093 /* Handle four memory cases, unaligned and aligned for either the input
2094 or the output. The only case where we can be called during reload is
2095 for aligned loads; all other cases require temporaries. */
2096
2097 if (any_memory_operand (operands[1], mode))
2098 {
2099 if (aligned_memory_operand (operands[1], mode))
2100 {
2101 if (reload_in_progress)
2102 {
2103 if (mode == QImode)
2104 seq = gen_reload_inqi_aligned (operands[0], operands[1]);
2105 else
2106 seq = gen_reload_inhi_aligned (operands[0], operands[1]);
2107 emit_insn (seq);
2108 }
2109 else
2110 {
2111 rtx aligned_mem, bitnum;
2112 rtx scratch = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
2113 rtx subtarget;
2114 bool copyout;
2115
2116 get_aligned_mem (operands[1], &aligned_mem, &bitnum);
2117
2118 subtarget = operands[0];
2119 if (REG_P (subtarget))
2120 subtarget = gen_lowpart (DImode, subtarget), copyout = false;
2121 else
2122 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (DImode), copyout = true;
2123
2124 if (mode == QImode)
2125 seq = gen_aligned_loadqi (subtarget, aligned_mem,
2126 bitnum, scratch);
2127 else
2128 seq = gen_aligned_loadhi (subtarget, aligned_mem,
2129 bitnum, scratch);
2130 emit_insn (seq);
2131
2132 if (copyout)
2133 emit_move_insn (operands[0], gen_lowpart (mode, subtarget));
2134 }
2135 }
2136 else
2137 {
2138 /* Don't pass these as parameters since that makes the generated
2139 code depend on parameter evaluation order which will cause
2140 bootstrap failures. */
2141
2142 rtx temp1, temp2, subtarget, ua;
2143 bool copyout;
2144
2145 temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2146 temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2147
2148 subtarget = operands[0];
2149 if (REG_P (subtarget))
2150 subtarget = gen_lowpart (DImode, subtarget), copyout = false;
2151 else
2152 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (DImode), copyout = true;
2153
2154 ua = get_unaligned_address (operands[1]);
2155 if (mode == QImode)
2156 seq = gen_unaligned_loadqi (subtarget, ua, temp1, temp2);
2157 else
2158 seq = gen_unaligned_loadhi (subtarget, ua, temp1, temp2);
2159
2160 alpha_set_memflags (seq, operands[1]);
2161 emit_insn (seq);
2162
2163 if (copyout)
2164 emit_move_insn (operands[0], gen_lowpart (mode, subtarget));
2165 }
2166 return true;
2167 }
2168
2169 if (any_memory_operand (operands[0], mode))
2170 {
2171 if (aligned_memory_operand (operands[0], mode))
2172 {
2173 rtx aligned_mem, bitnum;
2174 rtx temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
2175 rtx temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
2176
2177 get_aligned_mem (operands[0], &aligned_mem, &bitnum);
2178
2179 emit_insn (gen_aligned_store (aligned_mem, operands[1], bitnum,
2180 temp1, temp2));
2181 }
2182 else
2183 {
2184 rtx temp1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2185 rtx temp2 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2186 rtx temp3 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2187 rtx ua = get_unaligned_address (operands[0]);
2188
2189 if (mode == QImode)
2190 seq = gen_unaligned_storeqi (ua, operands[1], temp1, temp2, temp3);
2191 else
2192 seq = gen_unaligned_storehi (ua, operands[1], temp1, temp2, temp3);
2193
2194 alpha_set_memflags (seq, operands[0]);
2195 emit_insn (seq);
2196 }
2197 return true;
2198 }
2199
2200 return false;
2201 }
2202
2203 /* Implement the movmisalign patterns. One of the operands is a memory
2204 that is not naturally aligned. Emit instructions to load it. */
2205
2206 void
2207 alpha_expand_movmisalign (enum machine_mode mode, rtx *operands)
2208 {
2209 /* Honor misaligned loads, for those we promised to do so. */
2210 if (MEM_P (operands[1]))
2211 {
2212 rtx tmp;
2213
2214 if (register_operand (operands[0], mode))
2215 tmp = operands[0];
2216 else
2217 tmp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2218
2219 alpha_expand_unaligned_load (tmp, operands[1], 8, 0, 0);
2220 if (tmp != operands[0])
2221 emit_move_insn (operands[0], tmp);
2222 }
2223 else if (MEM_P (operands[0]))
2224 {
2225 if (!reg_or_0_operand (operands[1], mode))
2226 operands[1] = force_reg (mode, operands[1]);
2227 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (operands[0], operands[1], 8, 0);
2228 }
2229 else
2230 gcc_unreachable ();
2231 }
2232
2233 /* Generate an unsigned DImode to FP conversion. This is the same code
2234 optabs would emit if we didn't have TFmode patterns.
2235
2236 For SFmode, this is the only construction I've found that can pass
2237 gcc.c-torture/execute/ieee/rbug.c. No scenario that uses DFmode
2238 intermediates will work, because you'll get intermediate rounding
2239 that ruins the end result. Some of this could be fixed by turning
2240 on round-to-positive-infinity, but that requires diddling the fpsr,
2241 which kills performance. I tried turning this around and converting
2242 to a negative number, so that I could turn on /m, but either I did
2243 it wrong or there's something else cause I wound up with the exact
2244 same single-bit error. There is a branch-less form of this same code:
2245
2246 srl $16,1,$1
2247 and $16,1,$2
2248 cmplt $16,0,$3
2249 or $1,$2,$2
2250 cmovge $16,$16,$2
2251 itoft $3,$f10
2252 itoft $2,$f11
2253 cvtqs $f11,$f11
2254 adds $f11,$f11,$f0
2255 fcmoveq $f10,$f11,$f0
2256
2257 I'm not using it because it's the same number of instructions as
2258 this branch-full form, and it has more serialized long latency
2259 instructions on the critical path.
2260
2261 For DFmode, we can avoid rounding errors by breaking up the word
2262 into two pieces, converting them separately, and adding them back:
2263
2264 LC0: .long 0,0x5f800000
2265
2266 itoft $16,$f11
2267 lda $2,LC0
2268 cmplt $16,0,$1
2269 cpyse $f11,$f31,$f10
2270 cpyse $f31,$f11,$f11
2271 s4addq $1,$2,$1
2272 lds $f12,0($1)
2273 cvtqt $f10,$f10
2274 cvtqt $f11,$f11
2275 addt $f12,$f10,$f0
2276 addt $f0,$f11,$f0
2277
2278 This doesn't seem to be a clear-cut win over the optabs form.
2279 It probably all depends on the distribution of numbers being
2280 converted -- in the optabs form, all but high-bit-set has a
2281 much lower minimum execution time. */
2282
2283 void
2284 alpha_emit_floatuns (rtx operands[2])
2285 {
2286 rtx neglab, donelab, i0, i1, f0, in, out;
2287 enum machine_mode mode;
2288
2289 out = operands[0];
2290 in = force_reg (DImode, operands[1]);
2291 mode = GET_MODE (out);
2292 neglab = gen_label_rtx ();
2293 donelab = gen_label_rtx ();
2294 i0 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2295 i1 = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2296 f0 = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2297
2298 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (in, const0_rtx, LT, const0_rtx, DImode, 0, neglab);
2299
2300 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, gen_rtx_FLOAT (mode, in)));
2301 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (donelab));
2302 emit_barrier ();
2303
2304 emit_label (neglab);
2305
2306 emit_insn (gen_lshrdi3 (i0, in, const1_rtx));
2307 emit_insn (gen_anddi3 (i1, in, const1_rtx));
2308 emit_insn (gen_iordi3 (i0, i0, i1));
2309 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, f0, gen_rtx_FLOAT (mode, i0)));
2310 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, out, gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, f0, f0)));
2311
2312 emit_label (donelab);
2313 }
2314
2315 /* Generate the comparison for a conditional branch. */
2316
2317 void
2318 alpha_emit_conditional_branch (rtx operands[], enum machine_mode cmp_mode)
2319 {
2320 enum rtx_code cmp_code, branch_code;
2321 enum machine_mode branch_mode = VOIDmode;
2322 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
2323 rtx op0 = operands[1], op1 = operands[2];
2324 rtx tem;
2325
2326 if (cmp_mode == TFmode)
2327 {
2328 op0 = alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (&code, op0, op1);
2329 op1 = const0_rtx;
2330 cmp_mode = DImode;
2331 }
2332
2333 /* The general case: fold the comparison code to the types of compares
2334 that we have, choosing the branch as necessary. */
2335 switch (code)
2336 {
2337 case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2338 case UNORDERED:
2339 /* We have these compares: */
2340 cmp_code = code, branch_code = NE;
2341 break;
2342
2343 case NE:
2344 case ORDERED:
2345 /* These must be reversed. */
2346 cmp_code = reverse_condition (code), branch_code = EQ;
2347 break;
2348
2349 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2350 /* For FP, we swap them, for INT, we reverse them. */
2351 if (cmp_mode == DFmode)
2352 {
2353 cmp_code = swap_condition (code);
2354 branch_code = NE;
2355 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
2356 }
2357 else
2358 {
2359 cmp_code = reverse_condition (code);
2360 branch_code = EQ;
2361 }
2362 break;
2363
2364 default:
2365 gcc_unreachable ();
2366 }
2367
2368 if (cmp_mode == DFmode)
2369 {
2370 if (flag_unsafe_math_optimizations && cmp_code != UNORDERED)
2371 {
2372 /* When we are not as concerned about non-finite values, and we
2373 are comparing against zero, we can branch directly. */
2374 if (op1 == CONST0_RTX (DFmode))
2375 cmp_code = UNKNOWN, branch_code = code;
2376 else if (op0 == CONST0_RTX (DFmode))
2377 {
2378 /* Undo the swap we probably did just above. */
2379 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
2380 branch_code = swap_condition (cmp_code);
2381 cmp_code = UNKNOWN;
2382 }
2383 }
2384 else
2385 {
2386 /* ??? We mark the branch mode to be CCmode to prevent the
2387 compare and branch from being combined, since the compare
2388 insn follows IEEE rules that the branch does not. */
2389 branch_mode = CCmode;
2390 }
2391 }
2392 else
2393 {
2394 /* The following optimizations are only for signed compares. */
2395 if (code != LEU && code != LTU && code != GEU && code != GTU)
2396 {
2397 /* Whee. Compare and branch against 0 directly. */
2398 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
2399 cmp_code = UNKNOWN, branch_code = code;
2400
2401 /* If the constants doesn't fit into an immediate, but can
2402 be generated by lda/ldah, we adjust the argument and
2403 compare against zero, so we can use beq/bne directly. */
2404 /* ??? Don't do this when comparing against symbols, otherwise
2405 we'll reduce (&x == 0x1234) to (&x-0x1234 == 0), which will
2406 be declared false out of hand (at least for non-weak). */
2407 else if (CONST_INT_P (op1)
2408 && (code == EQ || code == NE)
2409 && !(symbolic_operand (op0, VOIDmode)
2410 || (REG_P (op0) && REG_POINTER (op0))))
2411 {
2412 rtx n_op1 = GEN_INT (-INTVAL (op1));
2413
2414 if (! satisfies_constraint_I (op1)
2415 && (satisfies_constraint_K (n_op1)
2416 || satisfies_constraint_L (n_op1)))
2417 cmp_code = PLUS, branch_code = code, op1 = n_op1;
2418 }
2419 }
2420
2421 if (!reg_or_0_operand (op0, DImode))
2422 op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0);
2423 if (cmp_code != PLUS && !reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode))
2424 op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1);
2425 }
2426
2427 /* Emit an initial compare instruction, if necessary. */
2428 tem = op0;
2429 if (cmp_code != UNKNOWN)
2430 {
2431 tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_mode);
2432 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, cmp_mode, op0, op1));
2433 }
2434
2435 /* Emit the branch instruction. */
2436 tem = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx,
2437 gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (VOIDmode,
2438 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (branch_code,
2439 branch_mode, tem,
2440 CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode)),
2441 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode,
2442 operands[3]),
2443 pc_rtx));
2444 emit_jump_insn (tem);
2445 }
2446
2447 /* Certain simplifications can be done to make invalid setcc operations
2448 valid. Return the final comparison, or NULL if we can't work. */
2449
2450 bool
2451 alpha_emit_setcc (rtx operands[], enum machine_mode cmp_mode)
2452 {
2453 enum rtx_code cmp_code;
2454 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (operands[1]);
2455 rtx op0 = operands[2], op1 = operands[3];
2456 rtx tmp;
2457
2458 if (cmp_mode == TFmode)
2459 {
2460 op0 = alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (&code, op0, op1);
2461 op1 = const0_rtx;
2462 cmp_mode = DImode;
2463 }
2464
2465 if (cmp_mode == DFmode && !TARGET_FIX)
2466 return 0;
2467
2468 /* The general case: fold the comparison code to the types of compares
2469 that we have, choosing the branch as necessary. */
2470
2471 cmp_code = UNKNOWN;
2472 switch (code)
2473 {
2474 case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2475 case UNORDERED:
2476 /* We have these compares. */
2477 if (cmp_mode == DFmode)
2478 cmp_code = code, code = NE;
2479 break;
2480
2481 case NE:
2482 if (cmp_mode == DImode && op1 == const0_rtx)
2483 break;
2484 /* FALLTHRU */
2485
2486 case ORDERED:
2487 cmp_code = reverse_condition (code);
2488 code = EQ;
2489 break;
2490
2491 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2492 /* These normally need swapping, but for integer zero we have
2493 special patterns that recognize swapped operands. */
2494 if (cmp_mode == DImode && op1 == const0_rtx)
2495 break;
2496 code = swap_condition (code);
2497 if (cmp_mode == DFmode)
2498 cmp_code = code, code = NE;
2499 tmp = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tmp;
2500 break;
2501
2502 default:
2503 gcc_unreachable ();
2504 }
2505
2506 if (cmp_mode == DImode)
2507 {
2508 if (!register_operand (op0, DImode))
2509 op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0);
2510 if (!reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode))
2511 op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1);
2512 }
2513
2514 /* Emit an initial compare instruction, if necessary. */
2515 if (cmp_code != UNKNOWN)
2516 {
2517 tmp = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_mode);
2518 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tmp,
2519 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, cmp_mode, op0, op1)));
2520
2521 op0 = cmp_mode != DImode ? gen_lowpart (DImode, tmp) : tmp;
2522 op1 = const0_rtx;
2523 }
2524
2525 /* Emit the setcc instruction. */
2526 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, operands[0],
2527 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, op0, op1)));
2528 return true;
2529 }
2530
2531
2532 /* Rewrite a comparison against zero CMP of the form
2533 (CODE (cc0) (const_int 0)) so it can be written validly in
2534 a conditional move (if_then_else CMP ...).
2535 If both of the operands that set cc0 are nonzero we must emit
2536 an insn to perform the compare (it can't be done within
2537 the conditional move). */
2538
2539 rtx
2540 alpha_emit_conditional_move (rtx cmp, enum machine_mode mode)
2541 {
2542 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (cmp);
2543 enum rtx_code cmov_code = NE;
2544 rtx op0 = XEXP (cmp, 0);
2545 rtx op1 = XEXP (cmp, 1);
2546 enum machine_mode cmp_mode
2547 = (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode ? DImode : GET_MODE (op0));
2548 enum machine_mode cmov_mode = VOIDmode;
2549 int local_fast_math = flag_unsafe_math_optimizations;
2550 rtx tem;
2551
2552 if (cmp_mode == TFmode)
2553 {
2554 op0 = alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (&code, op0, op1);
2555 op1 = const0_rtx;
2556 cmp_mode = DImode;
2557 }
2558
2559 gcc_assert (cmp_mode == DFmode || cmp_mode == DImode);
2560
2561 if (FLOAT_MODE_P (cmp_mode) != FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
2562 {
2563 enum rtx_code cmp_code;
2564
2565 if (! TARGET_FIX)
2566 return 0;
2567
2568 /* If we have fp<->int register move instructions, do a cmov by
2569 performing the comparison in fp registers, and move the
2570 zero/nonzero value to integer registers, where we can then
2571 use a normal cmov, or vice-versa. */
2572
2573 switch (code)
2574 {
2575 case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2576 /* We have these compares. */
2577 cmp_code = code, code = NE;
2578 break;
2579
2580 case NE:
2581 /* This must be reversed. */
2582 cmp_code = EQ, code = EQ;
2583 break;
2584
2585 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2586 /* These normally need swapping, but for integer zero we have
2587 special patterns that recognize swapped operands. */
2588 if (cmp_mode == DImode && op1 == const0_rtx)
2589 cmp_code = code, code = NE;
2590 else
2591 {
2592 cmp_code = swap_condition (code);
2593 code = NE;
2594 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
2595 }
2596 break;
2597
2598 default:
2599 gcc_unreachable ();
2600 }
2601
2602 tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_mode);
2603 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, tem,
2604 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmp_code, cmp_mode,
2605 op0, op1)));
2606
2607 cmp_mode = cmp_mode == DImode ? DFmode : DImode;
2608 op0 = gen_lowpart (cmp_mode, tem);
2609 op1 = CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode);
2610 local_fast_math = 1;
2611 }
2612
2613 /* We may be able to use a conditional move directly.
2614 This avoids emitting spurious compares. */
2615 if (signed_comparison_operator (cmp, VOIDmode)
2616 && (cmp_mode == DImode || local_fast_math)
2617 && (op0 == CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode) || op1 == CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode)))
2618 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, VOIDmode, op0, op1);
2619
2620 /* We can't put the comparison inside the conditional move;
2621 emit a compare instruction and put that inside the
2622 conditional move. Make sure we emit only comparisons we have;
2623 swap or reverse as necessary. */
2624
2625 if (!can_create_pseudo_p ())
2626 return NULL_RTX;
2627
2628 switch (code)
2629 {
2630 case EQ: case LE: case LT: case LEU: case LTU:
2631 /* We have these compares: */
2632 break;
2633
2634 case NE:
2635 /* This must be reversed. */
2636 code = reverse_condition (code);
2637 cmov_code = EQ;
2638 break;
2639
2640 case GE: case GT: case GEU: case GTU:
2641 /* These must be swapped. */
2642 if (op1 != CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode))
2643 {
2644 code = swap_condition (code);
2645 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
2646 }
2647 break;
2648
2649 default:
2650 gcc_unreachable ();
2651 }
2652
2653 if (cmp_mode == DImode)
2654 {
2655 if (!reg_or_0_operand (op0, DImode))
2656 op0 = force_reg (DImode, op0);
2657 if (!reg_or_8bit_operand (op1, DImode))
2658 op1 = force_reg (DImode, op1);
2659 }
2660
2661 /* ??? We mark the branch mode to be CCmode to prevent the compare
2662 and cmov from being combined, since the compare insn follows IEEE
2663 rules that the cmov does not. */
2664 if (cmp_mode == DFmode && !local_fast_math)
2665 cmov_mode = CCmode;
2666
2667 tem = gen_reg_rtx (cmp_mode);
2668 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, cmp_mode, op0, op1));
2669 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (cmov_code, cmov_mode, tem, CONST0_RTX (cmp_mode));
2670 }
2671
2672 /* Simplify a conditional move of two constants into a setcc with
2673 arithmetic. This is done with a splitter since combine would
2674 just undo the work if done during code generation. It also catches
2675 cases we wouldn't have before cse. */
2676
2677 int
2678 alpha_split_conditional_move (enum rtx_code code, rtx dest, rtx cond,
2679 rtx t_rtx, rtx f_rtx)
2680 {
2681 HOST_WIDE_INT t, f, diff;
2682 enum machine_mode mode;
2683 rtx target, subtarget, tmp;
2684
2685 mode = GET_MODE (dest);
2686 t = INTVAL (t_rtx);
2687 f = INTVAL (f_rtx);
2688 diff = t - f;
2689
2690 if (((code == NE || code == EQ) && diff < 0)
2691 || (code == GE || code == GT))
2692 {
2693 code = reverse_condition (code);
2694 diff = t, t = f, f = diff;
2695 diff = t - f;
2696 }
2697
2698 subtarget = target = dest;
2699 if (mode != DImode)
2700 {
2701 target = gen_lowpart (DImode, dest);
2702 if (can_create_pseudo_p ())
2703 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
2704 else
2705 subtarget = target;
2706 }
2707 /* Below, we must be careful to use copy_rtx on target and subtarget
2708 in intermediate insns, as they may be a subreg rtx, which may not
2709 be shared. */
2710
2711 if (f == 0 && exact_log2 (diff) > 0
2712 /* On EV6, we've got enough shifters to make non-arithmetic shifts
2713 viable over a longer latency cmove. On EV5, the E0 slot is a
2714 scarce resource, and on EV4 shift has the same latency as a cmove. */
2715 && (diff <= 8 || alpha_tune == PROCESSOR_EV6))
2716 {
2717 tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
2718 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp));
2719
2720 tmp = gen_rtx_ASHIFT (DImode, copy_rtx (subtarget),
2721 GEN_INT (exact_log2 (t)));
2722 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, tmp));
2723 }
2724 else if (f == 0 && t == -1)
2725 {
2726 tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
2727 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp));
2728
2729 emit_insn (gen_negdi2 (target, copy_rtx (subtarget)));
2730 }
2731 else if (diff == 1 || diff == 4 || diff == 8)
2732 {
2733 rtx add_op;
2734
2735 tmp = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
2736 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (subtarget), tmp));
2737
2738 if (diff == 1)
2739 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (target, copy_rtx (subtarget), GEN_INT (f)));
2740 else
2741 {
2742 add_op = GEN_INT (f);
2743 if (sext_add_operand (add_op, mode))
2744 {
2745 tmp = gen_rtx_MULT (DImode, copy_rtx (subtarget),
2746 GEN_INT (diff));
2747 tmp = gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, tmp, add_op);
2748 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, tmp));
2749 }
2750 else
2751 return 0;
2752 }
2753 }
2754 else
2755 return 0;
2756
2757 return 1;
2758 }
2759 \f
2760 /* Look up the function X_floating library function name for the
2761 given operation. */
2762
2763 struct GTY(()) xfloating_op
2764 {
2765 const enum rtx_code code;
2766 const char *const GTY((skip)) osf_func;
2767 const char *const GTY((skip)) vms_func;
2768 rtx libcall;
2769 };
2770
2771 static GTY(()) struct xfloating_op xfloating_ops[] =
2772 {
2773 { PLUS, "_OtsAddX", "OTS$ADD_X", 0 },
2774 { MINUS, "_OtsSubX", "OTS$SUB_X", 0 },
2775 { MULT, "_OtsMulX", "OTS$MUL_X", 0 },
2776 { DIV, "_OtsDivX", "OTS$DIV_X", 0 },
2777 { EQ, "_OtsEqlX", "OTS$EQL_X", 0 },
2778 { NE, "_OtsNeqX", "OTS$NEQ_X", 0 },
2779 { LT, "_OtsLssX", "OTS$LSS_X", 0 },
2780 { LE, "_OtsLeqX", "OTS$LEQ_X", 0 },
2781 { GT, "_OtsGtrX", "OTS$GTR_X", 0 },
2782 { GE, "_OtsGeqX", "OTS$GEQ_X", 0 },
2783 { FIX, "_OtsCvtXQ", "OTS$CVTXQ", 0 },
2784 { FLOAT, "_OtsCvtQX", "OTS$CVTQX", 0 },
2785 { UNSIGNED_FLOAT, "_OtsCvtQUX", "OTS$CVTQUX", 0 },
2786 { FLOAT_EXTEND, "_OtsConvertFloatTX", "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_T_X", 0 },
2787 { FLOAT_TRUNCATE, "_OtsConvertFloatXT", "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_X_T", 0 }
2788 };
2789
2790 static GTY(()) struct xfloating_op vax_cvt_ops[] =
2791 {
2792 { FLOAT_EXTEND, "_OtsConvertFloatGX", "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_G_X", 0 },
2793 { FLOAT_TRUNCATE, "_OtsConvertFloatXG", "OTS$CVT_FLOAT_X_G", 0 }
2794 };
2795
2796 static rtx
2797 alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (enum rtx_code code)
2798 {
2799 struct xfloating_op *ops = xfloating_ops;
2800 long n = ARRAY_SIZE (xfloating_ops);
2801 long i;
2802
2803 gcc_assert (TARGET_HAS_XFLOATING_LIBS);
2804
2805 /* How irritating. Nothing to key off for the main table. */
2806 if (TARGET_FLOAT_VAX && (code == FLOAT_EXTEND || code == FLOAT_TRUNCATE))
2807 {
2808 ops = vax_cvt_ops;
2809 n = ARRAY_SIZE (vax_cvt_ops);
2810 }
2811
2812 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i, ++ops)
2813 if (ops->code == code)
2814 {
2815 rtx func = ops->libcall;
2816 if (!func)
2817 {
2818 func = init_one_libfunc (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
2819 ? ops->vms_func : ops->osf_func);
2820 ops->libcall = func;
2821 }
2822 return func;
2823 }
2824
2825 gcc_unreachable ();
2826 }
2827
2828 /* Most X_floating operations take the rounding mode as an argument.
2829 Compute that here. */
2830
2831 static int
2832 alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (enum rtx_code code,
2833 enum alpha_fp_rounding_mode round)
2834 {
2835 int mode;
2836
2837 switch (round)
2838 {
2839 case ALPHA_FPRM_NORM:
2840 mode = 2;
2841 break;
2842 case ALPHA_FPRM_MINF:
2843 mode = 1;
2844 break;
2845 case ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP:
2846 mode = 0;
2847 break;
2848 case ALPHA_FPRM_DYN:
2849 mode = 4;
2850 break;
2851 default:
2852 gcc_unreachable ();
2853
2854 /* XXX For reference, round to +inf is mode = 3. */
2855 }
2856
2857 if (code == FLOAT_TRUNCATE && alpha_fptm == ALPHA_FPTM_N)
2858 mode |= 0x10000;
2859
2860 return mode;
2861 }
2862
2863 /* Emit an X_floating library function call.
2864
2865 Note that these functions do not follow normal calling conventions:
2866 TFmode arguments are passed in two integer registers (as opposed to
2867 indirect); TFmode return values appear in R16+R17.
2868
2869 FUNC is the function to call.
2870 TARGET is where the output belongs.
2871 OPERANDS are the inputs.
2872 NOPERANDS is the count of inputs.
2873 EQUIV is the expression equivalent for the function.
2874 */
2875
2876 static void
2877 alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (rtx func, rtx target, rtx operands[],
2878 int noperands, rtx equiv)
2879 {
2880 rtx usage = NULL_RTX, tmp, reg;
2881 int regno = 16, i;
2882
2883 start_sequence ();
2884
2885 for (i = 0; i < noperands; ++i)
2886 {
2887 switch (GET_MODE (operands[i]))
2888 {
2889 case TFmode:
2890 reg = gen_rtx_REG (TFmode, regno);
2891 regno += 2;
2892 break;
2893
2894 case DFmode:
2895 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, regno + 32);
2896 regno += 1;
2897 break;
2898
2899 case VOIDmode:
2900 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (operands[i]));
2901 /* FALLTHRU */
2902 case DImode:
2903 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno);
2904 regno += 1;
2905 break;
2906
2907 default:
2908 gcc_unreachable ();
2909 }
2910
2911 emit_move_insn (reg, operands[i]);
2912 use_reg (&usage, reg);
2913 }
2914
2915 switch (GET_MODE (target))
2916 {
2917 case TFmode:
2918 reg = gen_rtx_REG (TFmode, 16);
2919 break;
2920 case DFmode:
2921 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, 32);
2922 break;
2923 case DImode:
2924 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 0);
2925 break;
2926 default:
2927 gcc_unreachable ();
2928 }
2929
2930 tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (QImode, func);
2931 tmp = emit_call_insn (GEN_CALL_VALUE (reg, tmp, const0_rtx,
2932 const0_rtx, const0_rtx));
2933 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (tmp) = usage;
2934 RTL_CONST_CALL_P (tmp) = 1;
2935
2936 tmp = get_insns ();
2937 end_sequence ();
2938
2939 emit_libcall_block (tmp, target, reg, equiv);
2940 }
2941
2942 /* Emit an X_floating library function call for arithmetic (+,-,*,/). */
2943
2944 void
2945 alpha_emit_xfloating_arith (enum rtx_code code, rtx operands[])
2946 {
2947 rtx func;
2948 int mode;
2949 rtx out_operands[3];
2950
2951 func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (code);
2952 mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, alpha_fprm);
2953
2954 out_operands[0] = operands[1];
2955 out_operands[1] = operands[2];
2956 out_operands[2] = GEN_INT (mode);
2957 alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, operands[0], out_operands, 3,
2958 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, TFmode, operands[1],
2959 operands[2]));
2960 }
2961
2962 /* Emit an X_floating library function call for a comparison. */
2963
2964 static rtx
2965 alpha_emit_xfloating_compare (enum rtx_code *pcode, rtx op0, rtx op1)
2966 {
2967 enum rtx_code cmp_code, res_code;
2968 rtx func, out, operands[2], note;
2969
2970 /* X_floating library comparison functions return
2971 -1 unordered
2972 0 false
2973 1 true
2974 Convert the compare against the raw return value. */
2975
2976 cmp_code = *pcode;
2977 switch (cmp_code)
2978 {
2979 case UNORDERED:
2980 cmp_code = EQ;
2981 res_code = LT;
2982 break;
2983 case ORDERED:
2984 cmp_code = EQ;
2985 res_code = GE;
2986 break;
2987 case NE:
2988 res_code = NE;
2989 break;
2990 case EQ:
2991 case LT:
2992 case GT:
2993 case LE:
2994 case GE:
2995 res_code = GT;
2996 break;
2997 default:
2998 gcc_unreachable ();
2999 }
3000 *pcode = res_code;
3001
3002 func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (cmp_code);
3003
3004 operands[0] = op0;
3005 operands[1] = op1;
3006 out = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3007
3008 /* What's actually returned is -1,0,1, not a proper boolean value,
3009 so use an EXPR_LIST as with a generic libcall instead of a
3010 comparison type expression. */
3011 note = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, op1, NULL_RTX);
3012 note = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, op0, note);
3013 note = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, func, note);
3014 alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, out, operands, 2, note);
3015
3016 return out;
3017 }
3018
3019 /* Emit an X_floating library function call for a conversion. */
3020
3021 void
3022 alpha_emit_xfloating_cvt (enum rtx_code orig_code, rtx operands[])
3023 {
3024 int noperands = 1, mode;
3025 rtx out_operands[2];
3026 rtx func;
3027 enum rtx_code code = orig_code;
3028
3029 if (code == UNSIGNED_FIX)
3030 code = FIX;
3031
3032 func = alpha_lookup_xfloating_lib_func (code);
3033
3034 out_operands[0] = operands[1];
3035
3036 switch (code)
3037 {
3038 case FIX:
3039 mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP);
3040 out_operands[1] = GEN_INT (mode);
3041 noperands = 2;
3042 break;
3043 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
3044 mode = alpha_compute_xfloating_mode_arg (code, alpha_fprm);
3045 out_operands[1] = GEN_INT (mode);
3046 noperands = 2;
3047 break;
3048 default:
3049 break;
3050 }
3051
3052 alpha_emit_xfloating_libcall (func, operands[0], out_operands, noperands,
3053 gen_rtx_fmt_e (orig_code,
3054 GET_MODE (operands[0]),
3055 operands[1]));
3056 }
3057
3058 /* Split a TImode or TFmode move from OP[1] to OP[0] into a pair of
3059 DImode moves from OP[2,3] to OP[0,1]. If FIXUP_OVERLAP is true,
3060 guarantee that the sequence
3061 set (OP[0] OP[2])
3062 set (OP[1] OP[3])
3063 is valid. Naturally, output operand ordering is little-endian.
3064 This is used by *movtf_internal and *movti_internal. */
3065
3066 void
3067 alpha_split_tmode_pair (rtx operands[4], enum machine_mode mode,
3068 bool fixup_overlap)
3069 {
3070 switch (GET_CODE (operands[1]))
3071 {
3072 case REG:
3073 operands[3] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[1]) + 1);
3074 operands[2] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[1]));
3075 break;
3076
3077 case MEM:
3078 operands[3] = adjust_address (operands[1], DImode, 8);
3079 operands[2] = adjust_address (operands[1], DImode, 0);
3080 break;
3081
3082 case CONST_INT:
3083 case CONST_DOUBLE:
3084 gcc_assert (operands[1] == CONST0_RTX (mode));
3085 operands[2] = operands[3] = const0_rtx;
3086 break;
3087
3088 default:
3089 gcc_unreachable ();
3090 }
3091
3092 switch (GET_CODE (operands[0]))
3093 {
3094 case REG:
3095 operands[1] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[0]) + 1);
3096 operands[0] = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (operands[0]));
3097 break;
3098
3099 case MEM:
3100 operands[1] = adjust_address (operands[0], DImode, 8);
3101 operands[0] = adjust_address (operands[0], DImode, 0);
3102 break;
3103
3104 default:
3105 gcc_unreachable ();
3106 }
3107
3108 if (fixup_overlap && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (operands[0], operands[3]))
3109 {
3110 rtx tmp;
3111 tmp = operands[0], operands[0] = operands[1], operands[1] = tmp;
3112 tmp = operands[2], operands[2] = operands[3], operands[3] = tmp;
3113 }
3114 }
3115
3116 /* Implement negtf2 or abstf2. Op0 is destination, op1 is source,
3117 op2 is a register containing the sign bit, operation is the
3118 logical operation to be performed. */
3119
3120 void
3121 alpha_split_tfmode_frobsign (rtx operands[3], rtx (*operation) (rtx, rtx, rtx))
3122 {
3123 rtx high_bit = operands[2];
3124 rtx scratch;
3125 int move;
3126
3127 alpha_split_tmode_pair (operands, TFmode, false);
3128
3129 /* Detect three flavors of operand overlap. */
3130 move = 1;
3131 if (rtx_equal_p (operands[0], operands[2]))
3132 move = 0;
3133 else if (rtx_equal_p (operands[1], operands[2]))
3134 {
3135 if (rtx_equal_p (operands[0], high_bit))
3136 move = 2;
3137 else
3138 move = -1;
3139 }
3140
3141 if (move < 0)
3142 emit_move_insn (operands[0], operands[2]);
3143
3144 /* ??? If the destination overlaps both source tf and high_bit, then
3145 assume source tf is dead in its entirety and use the other half
3146 for a scratch register. Otherwise "scratch" is just the proper
3147 destination register. */
3148 scratch = operands[move < 2 ? 1 : 3];
3149
3150 emit_insn ((*operation) (scratch, high_bit, operands[3]));
3151
3152 if (move > 0)
3153 {
3154 emit_move_insn (operands[0], operands[2]);
3155 if (move > 1)
3156 emit_move_insn (operands[1], scratch);
3157 }
3158 }
3159 \f
3160 /* Use ext[wlq][lh] as the Architecture Handbook describes for extracting
3161 unaligned data:
3162
3163 unsigned: signed:
3164 word: ldq_u r1,X(r11) ldq_u r1,X(r11)
3165 ldq_u r2,X+1(r11) ldq_u r2,X+1(r11)
3166 lda r3,X(r11) lda r3,X+2(r11)
3167 extwl r1,r3,r1 extql r1,r3,r1
3168 extwh r2,r3,r2 extqh r2,r3,r2
3169 or r1.r2.r1 or r1,r2,r1
3170 sra r1,48,r1
3171
3172 long: ldq_u r1,X(r11) ldq_u r1,X(r11)
3173 ldq_u r2,X+3(r11) ldq_u r2,X+3(r11)
3174 lda r3,X(r11) lda r3,X(r11)
3175 extll r1,r3,r1 extll r1,r3,r1
3176 extlh r2,r3,r2 extlh r2,r3,r2
3177 or r1.r2.r1 addl r1,r2,r1
3178
3179 quad: ldq_u r1,X(r11)
3180 ldq_u r2,X+7(r11)
3181 lda r3,X(r11)
3182 extql r1,r3,r1
3183 extqh r2,r3,r2
3184 or r1.r2.r1
3185 */
3186
3187 void
3188 alpha_expand_unaligned_load (rtx tgt, rtx mem, HOST_WIDE_INT size,
3189 HOST_WIDE_INT ofs, int sign)
3190 {
3191 rtx meml, memh, addr, extl, exth, tmp, mema;
3192 enum machine_mode mode;
3193
3194 if (TARGET_BWX && size == 2)
3195 {
3196 meml = adjust_address (mem, QImode, ofs);
3197 memh = adjust_address (mem, QImode, ofs+1);
3198 extl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3199 exth = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3200 emit_insn (gen_zero_extendqidi2 (extl, meml));
3201 emit_insn (gen_zero_extendqidi2 (exth, memh));
3202 exth = expand_simple_binop (DImode, ASHIFT, exth, GEN_INT (8),
3203 NULL, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3204 addr = expand_simple_binop (DImode, IOR, extl, exth,
3205 NULL, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3206
3207 if (sign && GET_MODE (tgt) != HImode)
3208 {
3209 addr = gen_lowpart (HImode, addr);
3210 emit_insn (gen_extend_insn (tgt, addr, GET_MODE (tgt), HImode, 0));
3211 }
3212 else
3213 {
3214 if (GET_MODE (tgt) != DImode)
3215 addr = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (tgt), addr);
3216 emit_move_insn (tgt, addr);
3217 }
3218 return;
3219 }
3220
3221 meml = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3222 memh = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3223 addr = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3224 extl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3225 exth = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3226
3227 mema = XEXP (mem, 0);
3228 if (GET_CODE (mema) == LO_SUM)
3229 mema = force_reg (Pmode, mema);
3230
3231 /* AND addresses cannot be in any alias set, since they may implicitly
3232 alias surrounding code. Ideally we'd have some alias set that
3233 covered all types except those with alignment 8 or higher. */
3234
3235 tmp = change_address (mem, DImode,
3236 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3237 plus_constant (mema, ofs),
3238 GEN_INT (-8)));
3239 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
3240 emit_move_insn (meml, tmp);
3241
3242 tmp = change_address (mem, DImode,
3243 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3244 plus_constant (mema, ofs + size - 1),
3245 GEN_INT (-8)));
3246 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
3247 emit_move_insn (memh, tmp);
3248
3249 if (sign && size == 2)
3250 {
3251 emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, ofs+2));
3252
3253 emit_insn (gen_extql (extl, meml, addr));
3254 emit_insn (gen_extqh (exth, memh, addr));
3255
3256 /* We must use tgt here for the target. Alpha-vms port fails if we use
3257 addr for the target, because addr is marked as a pointer and combine
3258 knows that pointers are always sign-extended 32-bit values. */
3259 addr = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, extl, exth, tgt, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3260 addr = expand_binop (DImode, ashr_optab, addr, GEN_INT (48),
3261 addr, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3262 }
3263 else
3264 {
3265 emit_move_insn (addr, plus_constant (mema, ofs));
3266 emit_insn (gen_extxl (extl, meml, GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
3267 switch ((int) size)
3268 {
3269 case 2:
3270 emit_insn (gen_extwh (exth, memh, addr));
3271 mode = HImode;
3272 break;
3273 case 4:
3274 emit_insn (gen_extlh (exth, memh, addr));
3275 mode = SImode;
3276 break;
3277 case 8:
3278 emit_insn (gen_extqh (exth, memh, addr));
3279 mode = DImode;
3280 break;
3281 default:
3282 gcc_unreachable ();
3283 }
3284
3285 addr = expand_binop (mode, ior_optab, gen_lowpart (mode, extl),
3286 gen_lowpart (mode, exth), gen_lowpart (mode, tgt),
3287 sign, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3288 }
3289
3290 if (addr != tgt)
3291 emit_move_insn (tgt, gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (tgt), addr));
3292 }
3293
3294 /* Similarly, use ins and msk instructions to perform unaligned stores. */
3295
3296 void
3297 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (rtx dst, rtx src,
3298 HOST_WIDE_INT size, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs)
3299 {
3300 rtx dstl, dsth, addr, insl, insh, meml, memh, dsta;
3301
3302 if (TARGET_BWX && size == 2)
3303 {
3304 if (src != const0_rtx)
3305 {
3306 dstl = gen_lowpart (QImode, src);
3307 dsth = expand_simple_binop (DImode, LSHIFTRT, src, GEN_INT (8),
3308 NULL, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3309 dsth = gen_lowpart (QImode, dsth);
3310 }
3311 else
3312 dstl = dsth = const0_rtx;
3313
3314 meml = adjust_address (dst, QImode, ofs);
3315 memh = adjust_address (dst, QImode, ofs+1);
3316
3317 emit_move_insn (meml, dstl);
3318 emit_move_insn (memh, dsth);
3319 return;
3320 }
3321
3322 dstl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3323 dsth = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3324 insl = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3325 insh = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3326
3327 dsta = XEXP (dst, 0);
3328 if (GET_CODE (dsta) == LO_SUM)
3329 dsta = force_reg (Pmode, dsta);
3330
3331 /* AND addresses cannot be in any alias set, since they may implicitly
3332 alias surrounding code. Ideally we'd have some alias set that
3333 covered all types except those with alignment 8 or higher. */
3334
3335 meml = change_address (dst, DImode,
3336 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3337 plus_constant (dsta, ofs),
3338 GEN_INT (-8)));
3339 set_mem_alias_set (meml, 0);
3340
3341 memh = change_address (dst, DImode,
3342 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3343 plus_constant (dsta, ofs + size - 1),
3344 GEN_INT (-8)));
3345 set_mem_alias_set (memh, 0);
3346
3347 emit_move_insn (dsth, memh);
3348 emit_move_insn (dstl, meml);
3349
3350 addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (dsta, ofs));
3351
3352 if (src != CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (src)))
3353 {
3354 emit_insn (gen_insxh (insh, gen_lowpart (DImode, src),
3355 GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
3356
3357 switch ((int) size)
3358 {
3359 case 2:
3360 emit_insn (gen_inswl (insl, gen_lowpart (HImode, src), addr));
3361 break;
3362 case 4:
3363 emit_insn (gen_insll (insl, gen_lowpart (SImode, src), addr));
3364 break;
3365 case 8:
3366 emit_insn (gen_insql (insl, gen_lowpart (DImode, src), addr));
3367 break;
3368 default:
3369 gcc_unreachable ();
3370 }
3371 }
3372
3373 emit_insn (gen_mskxh (dsth, dsth, GEN_INT (size*8), addr));
3374
3375 switch ((int) size)
3376 {
3377 case 2:
3378 emit_insn (gen_mskwl (dstl, dstl, addr));
3379 break;
3380 case 4:
3381 emit_insn (gen_mskll (dstl, dstl, addr));
3382 break;
3383 case 8:
3384 emit_insn (gen_mskql (dstl, dstl, addr));
3385 break;
3386 default:
3387 gcc_unreachable ();
3388 }
3389
3390 if (src != CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (src)))
3391 {
3392 dsth = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, insh, dsth, dsth, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3393 dstl = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, insl, dstl, dstl, 0, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3394 }
3395
3396 /* Must store high before low for degenerate case of aligned. */
3397 emit_move_insn (memh, dsth);
3398 emit_move_insn (meml, dstl);
3399 }
3400
3401 /* The block move code tries to maximize speed by separating loads and
3402 stores at the expense of register pressure: we load all of the data
3403 before we store it back out. There are two secondary effects worth
3404 mentioning, that this speeds copying to/from aligned and unaligned
3405 buffers, and that it makes the code significantly easier to write. */
3406
3407 #define MAX_MOVE_WORDS 8
3408
3409 /* Load an integral number of consecutive unaligned quadwords. */
3410
3411 static void
3412 alpha_expand_unaligned_load_words (rtx *out_regs, rtx smem,
3413 HOST_WIDE_INT words, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs)
3414 {
3415 rtx const im8 = GEN_INT (-8);
3416 rtx ext_tmps[MAX_MOVE_WORDS], data_regs[MAX_MOVE_WORDS+1];
3417 rtx sreg, areg, tmp, smema;
3418 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
3419
3420 smema = XEXP (smem, 0);
3421 if (GET_CODE (smema) == LO_SUM)
3422 smema = force_reg (Pmode, smema);
3423
3424 /* Generate all the tmp registers we need. */
3425 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3426 {
3427 data_regs[i] = out_regs[i];
3428 ext_tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3429 }
3430 data_regs[words] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3431
3432 if (ofs != 0)
3433 smem = adjust_address (smem, GET_MODE (smem), ofs);
3434
3435 /* Load up all of the source data. */
3436 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3437 {
3438 tmp = change_address (smem, DImode,
3439 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3440 plus_constant (smema, 8*i),
3441 im8));
3442 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
3443 emit_move_insn (data_regs[i], tmp);
3444 }
3445
3446 tmp = change_address (smem, DImode,
3447 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3448 plus_constant (smema, 8*words - 1),
3449 im8));
3450 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
3451 emit_move_insn (data_regs[words], tmp);
3452
3453 /* Extract the half-word fragments. Unfortunately DEC decided to make
3454 extxh with offset zero a noop instead of zeroing the register, so
3455 we must take care of that edge condition ourselves with cmov. */
3456
3457 sreg = copy_addr_to_reg (smema);
3458 areg = expand_binop (DImode, and_optab, sreg, GEN_INT (7), NULL,
3459 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3460 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3461 {
3462 emit_insn (gen_extql (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], sreg));
3463 emit_insn (gen_extqh (ext_tmps[i], data_regs[i+1], sreg));
3464 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, ext_tmps[i],
3465 gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (DImode,
3466 gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, areg,
3467 const0_rtx),
3468 const0_rtx, ext_tmps[i])));
3469 }
3470
3471 /* Merge the half-words into whole words. */
3472 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3473 {
3474 out_regs[i] = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, data_regs[i],
3475 ext_tmps[i], data_regs[i], 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3476 }
3477 }
3478
3479 /* Store an integral number of consecutive unaligned quadwords. DATA_REGS
3480 may be NULL to store zeros. */
3481
3482 static void
3483 alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (rtx *data_regs, rtx dmem,
3484 HOST_WIDE_INT words, HOST_WIDE_INT ofs)
3485 {
3486 rtx const im8 = GEN_INT (-8);
3487 rtx ins_tmps[MAX_MOVE_WORDS];
3488 rtx st_tmp_1, st_tmp_2, dreg;
3489 rtx st_addr_1, st_addr_2, dmema;
3490 HOST_WIDE_INT i;
3491
3492 dmema = XEXP (dmem, 0);
3493 if (GET_CODE (dmema) == LO_SUM)
3494 dmema = force_reg (Pmode, dmema);
3495
3496 /* Generate all the tmp registers we need. */
3497 if (data_regs != NULL)
3498 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3499 ins_tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx(DImode);
3500 st_tmp_1 = gen_reg_rtx(DImode);
3501 st_tmp_2 = gen_reg_rtx(DImode);
3502
3503 if (ofs != 0)
3504 dmem = adjust_address (dmem, GET_MODE (dmem), ofs);
3505
3506 st_addr_2 = change_address (dmem, DImode,
3507 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3508 plus_constant (dmema, words*8 - 1),
3509 im8));
3510 set_mem_alias_set (st_addr_2, 0);
3511
3512 st_addr_1 = change_address (dmem, DImode,
3513 gen_rtx_AND (DImode, dmema, im8));
3514 set_mem_alias_set (st_addr_1, 0);
3515
3516 /* Load up the destination end bits. */
3517 emit_move_insn (st_tmp_2, st_addr_2);
3518 emit_move_insn (st_tmp_1, st_addr_1);
3519
3520 /* Shift the input data into place. */
3521 dreg = copy_addr_to_reg (dmema);
3522 if (data_regs != NULL)
3523 {
3524 for (i = words-1; i >= 0; --i)
3525 {
3526 emit_insn (gen_insqh (ins_tmps[i], data_regs[i], dreg));
3527 emit_insn (gen_insql (data_regs[i], data_regs[i], dreg));
3528 }
3529 for (i = words-1; i > 0; --i)
3530 {
3531 ins_tmps[i-1] = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, data_regs[i],
3532 ins_tmps[i-1], ins_tmps[i-1], 1,
3533 OPTAB_WIDEN);
3534 }
3535 }
3536
3537 /* Split and merge the ends with the destination data. */
3538 emit_insn (gen_mskqh (st_tmp_2, st_tmp_2, dreg));
3539 emit_insn (gen_mskql (st_tmp_1, st_tmp_1, dreg));
3540
3541 if (data_regs != NULL)
3542 {
3543 st_tmp_2 = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, st_tmp_2, ins_tmps[words-1],
3544 st_tmp_2, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3545 st_tmp_1 = expand_binop (DImode, ior_optab, st_tmp_1, data_regs[0],
3546 st_tmp_1, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3547 }
3548
3549 /* Store it all. */
3550 emit_move_insn (st_addr_2, st_tmp_2);
3551 for (i = words-1; i > 0; --i)
3552 {
3553 rtx tmp = change_address (dmem, DImode,
3554 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3555 plus_constant (dmema, i*8),
3556 im8));
3557 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, 0);
3558 emit_move_insn (tmp, data_regs ? ins_tmps[i-1] : const0_rtx);
3559 }
3560 emit_move_insn (st_addr_1, st_tmp_1);
3561 }
3562
3563
3564 /* Expand string/block move operations.
3565
3566 operands[0] is the pointer to the destination.
3567 operands[1] is the pointer to the source.
3568 operands[2] is the number of bytes to move.
3569 operands[3] is the alignment. */
3570
3571 int
3572 alpha_expand_block_move (rtx operands[])
3573 {
3574 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[2];
3575 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
3576 HOST_WIDE_INT orig_bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
3577 HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = orig_bytes;
3578 HOST_WIDE_INT src_align = INTVAL (align_rtx) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
3579 HOST_WIDE_INT dst_align = src_align;
3580 rtx orig_src = operands[1];
3581 rtx orig_dst = operands[0];
3582 rtx data_regs[2 * MAX_MOVE_WORDS + 16];
3583 rtx tmp;
3584 unsigned int i, words, ofs, nregs = 0;
3585
3586 if (orig_bytes <= 0)
3587 return 1;
3588 else if (orig_bytes > MAX_MOVE_WORDS * UNITS_PER_WORD)
3589 return 0;
3590
3591 /* Look for additional alignment information from recorded register info. */
3592
3593 tmp = XEXP (orig_src, 0);
3594 if (REG_P (tmp))
3595 src_align = MAX (src_align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp)));
3596 else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS
3597 && REG_P (XEXP (tmp, 0))
3598 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (tmp, 1)))
3599 {
3600 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1));
3601 unsigned int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0)));
3602
3603 if (a > src_align)
3604 {
3605 if (a >= 64 && c % 8 == 0)
3606 src_align = 64;
3607 else if (a >= 32 && c % 4 == 0)
3608 src_align = 32;
3609 else if (a >= 16 && c % 2 == 0)
3610 src_align = 16;
3611 }
3612 }
3613
3614 tmp = XEXP (orig_dst, 0);
3615 if (REG_P (tmp))
3616 dst_align = MAX (dst_align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp)));
3617 else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS
3618 && REG_P (XEXP (tmp, 0))
3619 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (tmp, 1)))
3620 {
3621 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1));
3622 unsigned int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0)));
3623
3624 if (a > dst_align)
3625 {
3626 if (a >= 64 && c % 8 == 0)
3627 dst_align = 64;
3628 else if (a >= 32 && c % 4 == 0)
3629 dst_align = 32;
3630 else if (a >= 16 && c % 2 == 0)
3631 dst_align = 16;
3632 }
3633 }
3634
3635 ofs = 0;
3636 if (src_align >= 64 && bytes >= 8)
3637 {
3638 words = bytes / 8;
3639
3640 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3641 data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3642
3643 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3644 emit_move_insn (data_regs[nregs + i],
3645 adjust_address (orig_src, DImode, ofs + i * 8));
3646
3647 nregs += words;
3648 bytes -= words * 8;
3649 ofs += words * 8;
3650 }
3651
3652 if (src_align >= 32 && bytes >= 4)
3653 {
3654 words = bytes / 4;
3655
3656 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3657 data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
3658
3659 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3660 emit_move_insn (data_regs[nregs + i],
3661 adjust_address (orig_src, SImode, ofs + i * 4));
3662
3663 nregs += words;
3664 bytes -= words * 4;
3665 ofs += words * 4;
3666 }
3667
3668 if (bytes >= 8)
3669 {
3670 words = bytes / 8;
3671
3672 for (i = 0; i < words+1; ++i)
3673 data_regs[nregs + i] = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
3674
3675 alpha_expand_unaligned_load_words (data_regs + nregs, orig_src,
3676 words, ofs);
3677
3678 nregs += words;
3679 bytes -= words * 8;
3680 ofs += words * 8;
3681 }
3682
3683 if (! TARGET_BWX && bytes >= 4)
3684 {
3685 data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
3686 alpha_expand_unaligned_load (tmp, orig_src, 4, ofs, 0);
3687 bytes -= 4;
3688 ofs += 4;
3689 }
3690
3691 if (bytes >= 2)
3692 {
3693 if (src_align >= 16)
3694 {
3695 do {
3696 data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (HImode);
3697 emit_move_insn (tmp, adjust_address (orig_src, HImode, ofs));
3698 bytes -= 2;
3699 ofs += 2;
3700 } while (bytes >= 2);
3701 }
3702 else if (! TARGET_BWX)
3703 {
3704 data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (HImode);
3705 alpha_expand_unaligned_load (tmp, orig_src, 2, ofs, 0);
3706 bytes -= 2;
3707 ofs += 2;
3708 }
3709 }
3710
3711 while (bytes > 0)
3712 {
3713 data_regs[nregs++] = tmp = gen_reg_rtx (QImode);
3714 emit_move_insn (tmp, adjust_address (orig_src, QImode, ofs));
3715 bytes -= 1;
3716 ofs += 1;
3717 }
3718
3719 gcc_assert (nregs <= ARRAY_SIZE (data_regs));
3720
3721 /* Now save it back out again. */
3722
3723 i = 0, ofs = 0;
3724
3725 /* Write out the data in whatever chunks reading the source allowed. */
3726 if (dst_align >= 64)
3727 {
3728 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode)
3729 {
3730 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs),
3731 data_regs[i]);
3732 ofs += 8;
3733 i++;
3734 }
3735 }
3736
3737 if (dst_align >= 32)
3738 {
3739 /* If the source has remaining DImode regs, write them out in
3740 two pieces. */
3741 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode)
3742 {
3743 tmp = expand_binop (DImode, lshr_optab, data_regs[i], GEN_INT (32),
3744 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3745
3746 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs),
3747 gen_lowpart (SImode, data_regs[i]));
3748 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs + 4),
3749 gen_lowpart (SImode, tmp));
3750 ofs += 8;
3751 i++;
3752 }
3753
3754 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == SImode)
3755 {
3756 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs),
3757 data_regs[i]);
3758 ofs += 4;
3759 i++;
3760 }
3761 }
3762
3763 if (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == DImode)
3764 {
3765 /* Write out a remaining block of words using unaligned methods. */
3766
3767 for (words = 1; i + words < nregs; words++)
3768 if (GET_MODE (data_regs[i + words]) != DImode)
3769 break;
3770
3771 if (words == 1)
3772 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 8, ofs);
3773 else
3774 alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (data_regs + i, orig_dst,
3775 words, ofs);
3776
3777 i += words;
3778 ofs += words * 8;
3779 }
3780
3781 /* Due to the above, this won't be aligned. */
3782 /* ??? If we have more than one of these, consider constructing full
3783 words in registers and using alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words. */
3784 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == SImode)
3785 {
3786 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 4, ofs);
3787 ofs += 4;
3788 i++;
3789 }
3790
3791 if (dst_align >= 16)
3792 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == HImode)
3793 {
3794 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs), data_regs[i]);
3795 i++;
3796 ofs += 2;
3797 }
3798 else
3799 while (i < nregs && GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == HImode)
3800 {
3801 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, data_regs[i], 2, ofs);
3802 i++;
3803 ofs += 2;
3804 }
3805
3806 /* The remainder must be byte copies. */
3807 while (i < nregs)
3808 {
3809 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (data_regs[i]) == QImode);
3810 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), data_regs[i]);
3811 i++;
3812 ofs += 1;
3813 }
3814
3815 return 1;
3816 }
3817
3818 int
3819 alpha_expand_block_clear (rtx operands[])
3820 {
3821 rtx bytes_rtx = operands[1];
3822 rtx align_rtx = operands[3];
3823 HOST_WIDE_INT orig_bytes = INTVAL (bytes_rtx);
3824 HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = orig_bytes;
3825 HOST_WIDE_INT align = INTVAL (align_rtx) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
3826 HOST_WIDE_INT alignofs = 0;
3827 rtx orig_dst = operands[0];
3828 rtx tmp;
3829 int i, words, ofs = 0;
3830
3831 if (orig_bytes <= 0)
3832 return 1;
3833 if (orig_bytes > MAX_MOVE_WORDS * UNITS_PER_WORD)
3834 return 0;
3835
3836 /* Look for stricter alignment. */
3837 tmp = XEXP (orig_dst, 0);
3838 if (REG_P (tmp))
3839 align = MAX (align, REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (tmp)));
3840 else if (GET_CODE (tmp) == PLUS
3841 && REG_P (XEXP (tmp, 0))
3842 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (tmp, 1)))
3843 {
3844 HOST_WIDE_INT c = INTVAL (XEXP (tmp, 1));
3845 int a = REGNO_POINTER_ALIGN (REGNO (XEXP (tmp, 0)));
3846
3847 if (a > align)
3848 {
3849 if (a >= 64)
3850 align = a, alignofs = 8 - c % 8;
3851 else if (a >= 32)
3852 align = a, alignofs = 4 - c % 4;
3853 else if (a >= 16)
3854 align = a, alignofs = 2 - c % 2;
3855 }
3856 }
3857
3858 /* Handle an unaligned prefix first. */
3859
3860 if (alignofs > 0)
3861 {
3862 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
3863 /* Given that alignofs is bounded by align, the only time BWX could
3864 generate three stores is for a 7 byte fill. Prefer two individual
3865 stores over a load/mask/store sequence. */
3866 if ((!TARGET_BWX || alignofs == 7)
3867 && align >= 32
3868 && !(alignofs == 4 && bytes >= 4))
3869 {
3870 enum machine_mode mode = (align >= 64 ? DImode : SImode);
3871 int inv_alignofs = (align >= 64 ? 8 : 4) - alignofs;
3872 rtx mem, tmp;
3873 HOST_WIDE_INT mask;
3874
3875 mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, mode, ofs - inv_alignofs);
3876 set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0);
3877
3878 mask = ~(~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (inv_alignofs * 8));
3879 if (bytes < alignofs)
3880 {
3881 mask |= ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << ((inv_alignofs + bytes) * 8);
3882 ofs += bytes;
3883 bytes = 0;
3884 }
3885 else
3886 {
3887 bytes -= alignofs;
3888 ofs += alignofs;
3889 }
3890 alignofs = 0;
3891
3892 tmp = expand_binop (mode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask),
3893 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
3894
3895 emit_move_insn (mem, tmp);
3896 }
3897 #endif
3898
3899 if (TARGET_BWX && (alignofs & 1) && bytes >= 1)
3900 {
3901 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
3902 bytes -= 1;
3903 ofs += 1;
3904 alignofs -= 1;
3905 }
3906 if (TARGET_BWX && align >= 16 && (alignofs & 3) == 2 && bytes >= 2)
3907 {
3908 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
3909 bytes -= 2;
3910 ofs += 2;
3911 alignofs -= 2;
3912 }
3913 if (alignofs == 4 && bytes >= 4)
3914 {
3915 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
3916 bytes -= 4;
3917 ofs += 4;
3918 alignofs = 0;
3919 }
3920
3921 /* If we've not used the extra lead alignment information by now,
3922 we won't be able to. Downgrade align to match what's left over. */
3923 if (alignofs > 0)
3924 {
3925 alignofs = alignofs & -alignofs;
3926 align = MIN (align, alignofs * BITS_PER_UNIT);
3927 }
3928 }
3929
3930 /* Handle a block of contiguous long-words. */
3931
3932 if (align >= 64 && bytes >= 8)
3933 {
3934 words = bytes / 8;
3935
3936 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3937 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs + i * 8),
3938 const0_rtx);
3939
3940 bytes -= words * 8;
3941 ofs += words * 8;
3942 }
3943
3944 /* If the block is large and appropriately aligned, emit a single
3945 store followed by a sequence of stq_u insns. */
3946
3947 if (align >= 32 && bytes > 16)
3948 {
3949 rtx orig_dsta;
3950
3951 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
3952 bytes -= 4;
3953 ofs += 4;
3954
3955 orig_dsta = XEXP (orig_dst, 0);
3956 if (GET_CODE (orig_dsta) == LO_SUM)
3957 orig_dsta = force_reg (Pmode, orig_dsta);
3958
3959 words = bytes / 8;
3960 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3961 {
3962 rtx mem
3963 = change_address (orig_dst, DImode,
3964 gen_rtx_AND (DImode,
3965 plus_constant (orig_dsta, ofs + i*8),
3966 GEN_INT (-8)));
3967 set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0);
3968 emit_move_insn (mem, const0_rtx);
3969 }
3970
3971 /* Depending on the alignment, the first stq_u may have overlapped
3972 with the initial stl, which means that the last stq_u didn't
3973 write as much as it would appear. Leave those questionable bytes
3974 unaccounted for. */
3975 bytes -= words * 8 - 4;
3976 ofs += words * 8 - 4;
3977 }
3978
3979 /* Handle a smaller block of aligned words. */
3980
3981 if ((align >= 64 && bytes == 4)
3982 || (align == 32 && bytes >= 4))
3983 {
3984 words = bytes / 4;
3985
3986 for (i = 0; i < words; ++i)
3987 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs + i * 4),
3988 const0_rtx);
3989
3990 bytes -= words * 4;
3991 ofs += words * 4;
3992 }
3993
3994 /* An unaligned block uses stq_u stores for as many as possible. */
3995
3996 if (bytes >= 8)
3997 {
3998 words = bytes / 8;
3999
4000 alpha_expand_unaligned_store_words (NULL, orig_dst, words, ofs);
4001
4002 bytes -= words * 8;
4003 ofs += words * 8;
4004 }
4005
4006 /* Next clean up any trailing pieces. */
4007
4008 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
4009 /* Count the number of bits in BYTES for which aligned stores could
4010 be emitted. */
4011 words = 0;
4012 for (i = (TARGET_BWX ? 1 : 4); i * BITS_PER_UNIT <= align ; i <<= 1)
4013 if (bytes & i)
4014 words += 1;
4015
4016 /* If we have appropriate alignment (and it wouldn't take too many
4017 instructions otherwise), mask out the bytes we need. */
4018 if (TARGET_BWX ? words > 2 : bytes > 0)
4019 {
4020 if (align >= 64)
4021 {
4022 rtx mem, tmp;
4023 HOST_WIDE_INT mask;
4024
4025 mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, DImode, ofs);
4026 set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0);
4027
4028 mask = ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (bytes * 8);
4029
4030 tmp = expand_binop (DImode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask),
4031 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4032
4033 emit_move_insn (mem, tmp);
4034 return 1;
4035 }
4036 else if (align >= 32 && bytes < 4)
4037 {
4038 rtx mem, tmp;
4039 HOST_WIDE_INT mask;
4040
4041 mem = adjust_address (orig_dst, SImode, ofs);
4042 set_mem_alias_set (mem, 0);
4043
4044 mask = ~(HOST_WIDE_INT)0 << (bytes * 8);
4045
4046 tmp = expand_binop (SImode, and_optab, mem, GEN_INT (mask),
4047 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4048
4049 emit_move_insn (mem, tmp);
4050 return 1;
4051 }
4052 }
4053 #endif
4054
4055 if (!TARGET_BWX && bytes >= 4)
4056 {
4057 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, const0_rtx, 4, ofs);
4058 bytes -= 4;
4059 ofs += 4;
4060 }
4061
4062 if (bytes >= 2)
4063 {
4064 if (align >= 16)
4065 {
4066 do {
4067 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, HImode, ofs),
4068 const0_rtx);
4069 bytes -= 2;
4070 ofs += 2;
4071 } while (bytes >= 2);
4072 }
4073 else if (! TARGET_BWX)
4074 {
4075 alpha_expand_unaligned_store (orig_dst, const0_rtx, 2, ofs);
4076 bytes -= 2;
4077 ofs += 2;
4078 }
4079 }
4080
4081 while (bytes > 0)
4082 {
4083 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (orig_dst, QImode, ofs), const0_rtx);
4084 bytes -= 1;
4085 ofs += 1;
4086 }
4087
4088 return 1;
4089 }
4090
4091 /* Returns a mask so that zap(x, value) == x & mask. */
4092
4093 rtx
4094 alpha_expand_zap_mask (HOST_WIDE_INT value)
4095 {
4096 rtx result;
4097 int i;
4098
4099 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
4100 {
4101 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0;
4102
4103 for (i = 7; i >= 0; --i)
4104 {
4105 mask <<= 8;
4106 if (!((value >> i) & 1))
4107 mask |= 0xff;
4108 }
4109
4110 result = gen_int_mode (mask, DImode);
4111 }
4112 else
4113 {
4114 HOST_WIDE_INT mask_lo = 0, mask_hi = 0;
4115
4116 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32);
4117
4118 for (i = 7; i >= 4; --i)
4119 {
4120 mask_hi <<= 8;
4121 if (!((value >> i) & 1))
4122 mask_hi |= 0xff;
4123 }
4124
4125 for (i = 3; i >= 0; --i)
4126 {
4127 mask_lo <<= 8;
4128 if (!((value >> i) & 1))
4129 mask_lo |= 0xff;
4130 }
4131
4132 result = immed_double_const (mask_lo, mask_hi, DImode);
4133 }
4134
4135 return result;
4136 }
4137
4138 void
4139 alpha_expand_builtin_vector_binop (rtx (*gen) (rtx, rtx, rtx),
4140 enum machine_mode mode,
4141 rtx op0, rtx op1, rtx op2)
4142 {
4143 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
4144
4145 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
4146 op1 = CONST0_RTX (mode);
4147 else
4148 op1 = gen_lowpart (mode, op1);
4149
4150 if (op2 == const0_rtx)
4151 op2 = CONST0_RTX (mode);
4152 else
4153 op2 = gen_lowpart (mode, op2);
4154
4155 emit_insn ((*gen) (op0, op1, op2));
4156 }
4157
4158 /* A subroutine of the atomic operation splitters. Jump to LABEL if
4159 COND is true. Mark the jump as unlikely to be taken. */
4160
4161 static void
4162 emit_unlikely_jump (rtx cond, rtx label)
4163 {
4164 rtx very_unlikely = GEN_INT (REG_BR_PROB_BASE / 100 - 1);
4165 rtx x;
4166
4167 x = gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (VOIDmode, cond, label, pc_rtx);
4168 x = emit_jump_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, pc_rtx, x));
4169 add_reg_note (x, REG_BR_PROB, very_unlikely);
4170 }
4171
4172 /* A subroutine of the atomic operation splitters. Emit a load-locked
4173 instruction in MODE. */
4174
4175 static void
4176 emit_load_locked (enum machine_mode mode, rtx reg, rtx mem)
4177 {
4178 rtx (*fn) (rtx, rtx) = NULL;
4179 if (mode == SImode)
4180 fn = gen_load_locked_si;
4181 else if (mode == DImode)
4182 fn = gen_load_locked_di;
4183 emit_insn (fn (reg, mem));
4184 }
4185
4186 /* A subroutine of the atomic operation splitters. Emit a store-conditional
4187 instruction in MODE. */
4188
4189 static void
4190 emit_store_conditional (enum machine_mode mode, rtx res, rtx mem, rtx val)
4191 {
4192 rtx (*fn) (rtx, rtx, rtx) = NULL;
4193 if (mode == SImode)
4194 fn = gen_store_conditional_si;
4195 else if (mode == DImode)
4196 fn = gen_store_conditional_di;
4197 emit_insn (fn (res, mem, val));
4198 }
4199
4200 /* Subroutines of the atomic operation splitters. Emit barriers
4201 as needed for the memory MODEL. */
4202
4203 static void
4204 alpha_pre_atomic_barrier (enum memmodel model)
4205 {
4206 switch (model)
4207 {
4208 case MEMMODEL_RELAXED:
4209 case MEMMODEL_CONSUME:
4210 case MEMMODEL_ACQUIRE:
4211 break;
4212 case MEMMODEL_RELEASE:
4213 case MEMMODEL_ACQ_REL:
4214 case MEMMODEL_SEQ_CST:
4215 emit_insn (gen_memory_barrier ());
4216 break;
4217 default:
4218 gcc_unreachable ();
4219 }
4220 }
4221
4222 static void
4223 alpha_post_atomic_barrier (enum memmodel model)
4224 {
4225 switch (model)
4226 {
4227 case MEMMODEL_RELAXED:
4228 case MEMMODEL_CONSUME:
4229 case MEMMODEL_RELEASE:
4230 break;
4231 case MEMMODEL_ACQUIRE:
4232 case MEMMODEL_ACQ_REL:
4233 case MEMMODEL_SEQ_CST:
4234 emit_insn (gen_memory_barrier ());
4235 break;
4236 default:
4237 gcc_unreachable ();
4238 }
4239 }
4240
4241 /* A subroutine of the atomic operation splitters. Emit an insxl
4242 instruction in MODE. */
4243
4244 static rtx
4245 emit_insxl (enum machine_mode mode, rtx op1, rtx op2)
4246 {
4247 rtx ret = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4248 rtx (*fn) (rtx, rtx, rtx);
4249
4250 switch (mode)
4251 {
4252 case QImode:
4253 fn = gen_insbl;
4254 break;
4255 case HImode:
4256 fn = gen_inswl;
4257 break;
4258 case SImode:
4259 fn = gen_insll;
4260 break;
4261 case DImode:
4262 fn = gen_insql;
4263 break;
4264 default:
4265 gcc_unreachable ();
4266 }
4267
4268 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
4269 emit_insn (fn (ret, op1, op2));
4270
4271 return ret;
4272 }
4273
4274 /* Expand an atomic fetch-and-operate pattern. CODE is the binary operation
4275 to perform. MEM is the memory on which to operate. VAL is the second
4276 operand of the binary operator. BEFORE and AFTER are optional locations to
4277 return the value of MEM either before of after the operation. SCRATCH is
4278 a scratch register. */
4279
4280 void
4281 alpha_split_atomic_op (enum rtx_code code, rtx mem, rtx val, rtx before,
4282 rtx after, rtx scratch, enum memmodel model)
4283 {
4284 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (mem);
4285 rtx label, x, cond = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REGNO (scratch));
4286
4287 alpha_pre_atomic_barrier (model);
4288
4289 label = gen_label_rtx ();
4290 emit_label (label);
4291 label = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (DImode, label);
4292
4293 if (before == NULL)
4294 before = scratch;
4295 emit_load_locked (mode, before, mem);
4296
4297 if (code == NOT)
4298 {
4299 x = gen_rtx_AND (mode, before, val);
4300 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, val, x));
4301
4302 x = gen_rtx_NOT (mode, val);
4303 }
4304 else
4305 x = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, mode, before, val);
4306 if (after)
4307 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, after, copy_rtx (x)));
4308 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, scratch, x));
4309
4310 emit_store_conditional (mode, cond, mem, scratch);
4311
4312 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
4313 emit_unlikely_jump (x, label);
4314
4315 alpha_post_atomic_barrier (model);
4316 }
4317
4318 /* Expand a compare and swap operation. */
4319
4320 void
4321 alpha_split_compare_and_swap (rtx operands[])
4322 {
4323 rtx cond, retval, mem, oldval, newval;
4324 bool is_weak;
4325 enum memmodel mod_s, mod_f;
4326 enum machine_mode mode;
4327 rtx label1, label2, x;
4328
4329 cond = operands[0];
4330 retval = operands[1];
4331 mem = operands[2];
4332 oldval = operands[3];
4333 newval = operands[4];
4334 is_weak = (operands[5] != const0_rtx);
4335 mod_s = (enum memmodel) INTVAL (operands[6]);
4336 mod_f = (enum memmodel) INTVAL (operands[7]);
4337 mode = GET_MODE (mem);
4338
4339 alpha_pre_atomic_barrier (mod_s);
4340
4341 label1 = NULL_RTX;
4342 if (!is_weak)
4343 {
4344 label1 = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (DImode, gen_label_rtx ());
4345 emit_label (XEXP (label1, 0));
4346 }
4347 label2 = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (DImode, gen_label_rtx ());
4348
4349 emit_load_locked (mode, retval, mem);
4350
4351 x = gen_lowpart (DImode, retval);
4352 if (oldval == const0_rtx)
4353 {
4354 emit_move_insn (cond, const0_rtx);
4355 x = gen_rtx_NE (DImode, x, const0_rtx);
4356 }
4357 else
4358 {
4359 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, x, oldval);
4360 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cond, x));
4361 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
4362 }
4363 emit_unlikely_jump (x, label2);
4364
4365 emit_move_insn (cond, newval);
4366 emit_store_conditional (mode, cond, mem, gen_lowpart (mode, cond));
4367
4368 if (!is_weak)
4369 {
4370 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
4371 emit_unlikely_jump (x, label1);
4372 }
4373
4374 if (mod_f != MEMMODEL_RELAXED)
4375 emit_label (XEXP (label2, 0));
4376
4377 alpha_post_atomic_barrier (mod_s);
4378
4379 if (mod_f == MEMMODEL_RELAXED)
4380 emit_label (XEXP (label2, 0));
4381 }
4382
4383 void
4384 alpha_expand_compare_and_swap_12 (rtx operands[])
4385 {
4386 rtx cond, dst, mem, oldval, newval, is_weak, mod_s, mod_f;
4387 enum machine_mode mode;
4388 rtx addr, align, wdst;
4389 rtx (*gen) (rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx);
4390
4391 cond = operands[0];
4392 dst = operands[1];
4393 mem = operands[2];
4394 oldval = operands[3];
4395 newval = operands[4];
4396 is_weak = operands[5];
4397 mod_s = operands[6];
4398 mod_f = operands[7];
4399 mode = GET_MODE (mem);
4400
4401 /* We forced the address into a register via mem_noofs_operand. */
4402 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
4403 gcc_assert (register_operand (addr, DImode));
4404
4405 align = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, AND, addr, GEN_INT (-8),
4406 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_DIRECT);
4407
4408 oldval = convert_modes (DImode, mode, oldval, 1);
4409
4410 if (newval != const0_rtx)
4411 newval = emit_insxl (mode, newval, addr);
4412
4413 wdst = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4414 if (mode == QImode)
4415 gen = gen_atomic_compare_and_swapqi_1;
4416 else
4417 gen = gen_atomic_compare_and_swaphi_1;
4418 emit_insn (gen (cond, wdst, mem, oldval, newval, align,
4419 is_weak, mod_s, mod_f));
4420
4421 emit_move_insn (dst, gen_lowpart (mode, wdst));
4422 }
4423
4424 void
4425 alpha_split_compare_and_swap_12 (rtx operands[])
4426 {
4427 rtx cond, dest, orig_mem, oldval, newval, align, scratch;
4428 enum machine_mode mode;
4429 bool is_weak;
4430 enum memmodel mod_s, mod_f;
4431 rtx label1, label2, mem, addr, width, mask, x;
4432
4433 cond = operands[0];
4434 dest = operands[1];
4435 orig_mem = operands[2];
4436 oldval = operands[3];
4437 newval = operands[4];
4438 align = operands[5];
4439 is_weak = (operands[6] != const0_rtx);
4440 mod_s = (enum memmodel) INTVAL (operands[7]);
4441 mod_f = (enum memmodel) INTVAL (operands[8]);
4442 scratch = operands[9];
4443 mode = GET_MODE (orig_mem);
4444 addr = XEXP (orig_mem, 0);
4445
4446 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, align);
4447 MEM_VOLATILE_P (mem) = MEM_VOLATILE_P (orig_mem);
4448 if (MEM_ALIAS_SET (orig_mem) == ALIAS_SET_MEMORY_BARRIER)
4449 set_mem_alias_set (mem, ALIAS_SET_MEMORY_BARRIER);
4450
4451 alpha_pre_atomic_barrier (mod_s);
4452
4453 label1 = NULL_RTX;
4454 if (!is_weak)
4455 {
4456 label1 = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (DImode, gen_label_rtx ());
4457 emit_label (XEXP (label1, 0));
4458 }
4459 label2 = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (DImode, gen_label_rtx ());
4460
4461 emit_load_locked (DImode, scratch, mem);
4462
4463 width = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode));
4464 mask = GEN_INT (mode == QImode ? 0xff : 0xffff);
4465 emit_insn (gen_extxl (dest, scratch, width, addr));
4466
4467 if (oldval == const0_rtx)
4468 {
4469 emit_move_insn (cond, const0_rtx);
4470 x = gen_rtx_NE (DImode, dest, const0_rtx);
4471 }
4472 else
4473 {
4474 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, dest, oldval);
4475 emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, cond, x));
4476 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
4477 }
4478 emit_unlikely_jump (x, label2);
4479
4480 emit_insn (gen_mskxl (cond, scratch, mask, addr));
4481
4482 if (newval != const0_rtx)
4483 emit_insn (gen_iordi3 (cond, cond, newval));
4484
4485 emit_store_conditional (DImode, cond, mem, cond);
4486
4487 if (!is_weak)
4488 {
4489 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
4490 emit_unlikely_jump (x, label1);
4491 }
4492
4493 if (mod_f != MEMMODEL_RELAXED)
4494 emit_label (XEXP (label2, 0));
4495
4496 alpha_post_atomic_barrier (mod_s);
4497
4498 if (mod_f == MEMMODEL_RELAXED)
4499 emit_label (XEXP (label2, 0));
4500 }
4501
4502 /* Expand an atomic exchange operation. */
4503
4504 void
4505 alpha_split_atomic_exchange (rtx operands[])
4506 {
4507 rtx retval, mem, val, scratch;
4508 enum memmodel model;
4509 enum machine_mode mode;
4510 rtx label, x, cond;
4511
4512 retval = operands[0];
4513 mem = operands[1];
4514 val = operands[2];
4515 model = (enum memmodel) INTVAL (operands[3]);
4516 scratch = operands[4];
4517 mode = GET_MODE (mem);
4518 cond = gen_lowpart (DImode, scratch);
4519
4520 alpha_pre_atomic_barrier (model);
4521
4522 label = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (DImode, gen_label_rtx ());
4523 emit_label (XEXP (label, 0));
4524
4525 emit_load_locked (mode, retval, mem);
4526 emit_move_insn (scratch, val);
4527 emit_store_conditional (mode, cond, mem, scratch);
4528
4529 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, cond, const0_rtx);
4530 emit_unlikely_jump (x, label);
4531
4532 alpha_post_atomic_barrier (model);
4533 }
4534
4535 void
4536 alpha_expand_atomic_exchange_12 (rtx operands[])
4537 {
4538 rtx dst, mem, val, model;
4539 enum machine_mode mode;
4540 rtx addr, align, wdst;
4541 rtx (*gen) (rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx);
4542
4543 dst = operands[0];
4544 mem = operands[1];
4545 val = operands[2];
4546 model = operands[3];
4547 mode = GET_MODE (mem);
4548
4549 /* We forced the address into a register via mem_noofs_operand. */
4550 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
4551 gcc_assert (register_operand (addr, DImode));
4552
4553 align = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, AND, addr, GEN_INT (-8),
4554 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_DIRECT);
4555
4556 /* Insert val into the correct byte location within the word. */
4557 if (val != const0_rtx)
4558 val = emit_insxl (mode, val, addr);
4559
4560 wdst = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
4561 if (mode == QImode)
4562 gen = gen_atomic_exchangeqi_1;
4563 else
4564 gen = gen_atomic_exchangehi_1;
4565 emit_insn (gen (wdst, mem, val, align, model));
4566
4567 emit_move_insn (dst, gen_lowpart (mode, wdst));
4568 }
4569
4570 void
4571 alpha_split_atomic_exchange_12 (rtx operands[])
4572 {
4573 rtx dest, orig_mem, addr, val, align, scratch;
4574 rtx label, mem, width, mask, x;
4575 enum machine_mode mode;
4576 enum memmodel model;
4577
4578 dest = operands[0];
4579 orig_mem = operands[1];
4580 val = operands[2];
4581 align = operands[3];
4582 model = (enum memmodel) INTVAL (operands[4]);
4583 scratch = operands[5];
4584 mode = GET_MODE (orig_mem);
4585 addr = XEXP (orig_mem, 0);
4586
4587 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, align);
4588 MEM_VOLATILE_P (mem) = MEM_VOLATILE_P (orig_mem);
4589 if (MEM_ALIAS_SET (orig_mem) == ALIAS_SET_MEMORY_BARRIER)
4590 set_mem_alias_set (mem, ALIAS_SET_MEMORY_BARRIER);
4591
4592 alpha_pre_atomic_barrier (model);
4593
4594 label = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (DImode, gen_label_rtx ());
4595 emit_label (XEXP (label, 0));
4596
4597 emit_load_locked (DImode, scratch, mem);
4598
4599 width = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode));
4600 mask = GEN_INT (mode == QImode ? 0xff : 0xffff);
4601 emit_insn (gen_extxl (dest, scratch, width, addr));
4602 emit_insn (gen_mskxl (scratch, scratch, mask, addr));
4603 if (val != const0_rtx)
4604 emit_insn (gen_iordi3 (scratch, scratch, val));
4605
4606 emit_store_conditional (DImode, scratch, mem, scratch);
4607
4608 x = gen_rtx_EQ (DImode, scratch, const0_rtx);
4609 emit_unlikely_jump (x, label);
4610
4611 alpha_post_atomic_barrier (model);
4612 }
4613 \f
4614 /* Adjust the cost of a scheduling dependency. Return the new cost of
4615 a dependency LINK or INSN on DEP_INSN. COST is the current cost. */
4616
4617 static int
4618 alpha_adjust_cost (rtx insn, rtx link, rtx dep_insn, int cost)
4619 {
4620 enum attr_type dep_insn_type;
4621
4622 /* If the dependence is an anti-dependence, there is no cost. For an
4623 output dependence, there is sometimes a cost, but it doesn't seem
4624 worth handling those few cases. */
4625 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) != 0)
4626 return cost;
4627
4628 /* If we can't recognize the insns, we can't really do anything. */
4629 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0 || recog_memoized (dep_insn) < 0)
4630 return cost;
4631
4632 dep_insn_type = get_attr_type (dep_insn);
4633
4634 /* Bring in the user-defined memory latency. */
4635 if (dep_insn_type == TYPE_ILD
4636 || dep_insn_type == TYPE_FLD
4637 || dep_insn_type == TYPE_LDSYM)
4638 cost += alpha_memory_latency-1;
4639
4640 /* Everything else handled in DFA bypasses now. */
4641
4642 return cost;
4643 }
4644
4645 /* The number of instructions that can be issued per cycle. */
4646
4647 static int
4648 alpha_issue_rate (void)
4649 {
4650 return (alpha_tune == PROCESSOR_EV4 ? 2 : 4);
4651 }
4652
4653 /* How many alternative schedules to try. This should be as wide as the
4654 scheduling freedom in the DFA, but no wider. Making this value too
4655 large results extra work for the scheduler.
4656
4657 For EV4, loads can be issued to either IB0 or IB1, thus we have 2
4658 alternative schedules. For EV5, we can choose between E0/E1 and
4659 FA/FM. For EV6, an arithmetic insn can be issued to U0/U1/L0/L1. */
4660
4661 static int
4662 alpha_multipass_dfa_lookahead (void)
4663 {
4664 return (alpha_tune == PROCESSOR_EV6 ? 4 : 2);
4665 }
4666 \f
4667 /* Machine-specific function data. */
4668
4669 struct GTY(()) alpha_links;
4670
4671 struct GTY(()) machine_function
4672 {
4673 /* For OSF. */
4674 const char *some_ld_name;
4675
4676 /* For TARGET_LD_BUGGY_LDGP. */
4677 rtx gp_save_rtx;
4678
4679 /* For VMS condition handlers. */
4680 bool uses_condition_handler;
4681
4682 /* Linkage entries. */
4683 splay_tree GTY ((param1_is (char *), param2_is (struct alpha_links *)))
4684 links;
4685 };
4686
4687 /* How to allocate a 'struct machine_function'. */
4688
4689 static struct machine_function *
4690 alpha_init_machine_status (void)
4691 {
4692 return ggc_alloc_cleared_machine_function ();
4693 }
4694
4695 /* Support for frame based VMS condition handlers. */
4696
4697 /* A VMS condition handler may be established for a function with a call to
4698 __builtin_establish_vms_condition_handler, and cancelled with a call to
4699 __builtin_revert_vms_condition_handler.
4700
4701 The VMS Condition Handling Facility knows about the existence of a handler
4702 from the procedure descriptor .handler field. As the VMS native compilers,
4703 we store the user specified handler's address at a fixed location in the
4704 stack frame and point the procedure descriptor at a common wrapper which
4705 fetches the real handler's address and issues an indirect call.
4706
4707 The indirection wrapper is "__gcc_shell_handler", provided by libgcc.
4708
4709 We force the procedure kind to PT_STACK, and the fixed frame location is
4710 fp+8, just before the register save area. We use the handler_data field in
4711 the procedure descriptor to state the fp offset at which the installed
4712 handler address can be found. */
4713
4714 #define VMS_COND_HANDLER_FP_OFFSET 8
4715
4716 /* Expand code to store the currently installed user VMS condition handler
4717 into TARGET and install HANDLER as the new condition handler. */
4718
4719 void
4720 alpha_expand_builtin_establish_vms_condition_handler (rtx target, rtx handler)
4721 {
4722 rtx handler_slot_address
4723 = plus_constant (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, VMS_COND_HANDLER_FP_OFFSET);
4724
4725 rtx handler_slot
4726 = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, handler_slot_address);
4727
4728 emit_move_insn (target, handler_slot);
4729 emit_move_insn (handler_slot, handler);
4730
4731 /* Notify the start/prologue/epilogue emitters that the condition handler
4732 slot is needed. In addition to reserving the slot space, this will force
4733 the procedure kind to PT_STACK so ensure that the hard_frame_pointer_rtx
4734 use above is correct. */
4735 cfun->machine->uses_condition_handler = true;
4736 }
4737
4738 /* Expand code to store the current VMS condition handler into TARGET and
4739 nullify it. */
4740
4741 void
4742 alpha_expand_builtin_revert_vms_condition_handler (rtx target)
4743 {
4744 /* We implement this by establishing a null condition handler, with the tiny
4745 side effect of setting uses_condition_handler. This is a little bit
4746 pessimistic if no actual builtin_establish call is ever issued, which is
4747 not a real problem and expected never to happen anyway. */
4748
4749 alpha_expand_builtin_establish_vms_condition_handler (target, const0_rtx);
4750 }
4751
4752 /* Functions to save and restore alpha_return_addr_rtx. */
4753
4754 /* Start the ball rolling with RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
4755
4756 rtx
4757 alpha_return_addr (int count, rtx frame ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4758 {
4759 if (count != 0)
4760 return const0_rtx;
4761
4762 return get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, REG_RA);
4763 }
4764
4765 /* Return or create a memory slot containing the gp value for the current
4766 function. Needed only if TARGET_LD_BUGGY_LDGP. */
4767
4768 rtx
4769 alpha_gp_save_rtx (void)
4770 {
4771 rtx seq, m = cfun->machine->gp_save_rtx;
4772
4773 if (m == NULL)
4774 {
4775 start_sequence ();
4776
4777 m = assign_stack_local (DImode, UNITS_PER_WORD, BITS_PER_WORD);
4778 m = validize_mem (m);
4779 emit_move_insn (m, pic_offset_table_rtx);
4780
4781 seq = get_insns ();
4782 end_sequence ();
4783
4784 /* We used to simply emit the sequence after entry_of_function.
4785 However this breaks the CFG if the first instruction in the
4786 first block is not the NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK, for example a
4787 label. Emit the sequence properly on the edge. We are only
4788 invoked from dw2_build_landing_pads and finish_eh_generation
4789 will call commit_edge_insertions thanks to a kludge. */
4790 insert_insn_on_edge (seq, single_succ_edge (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR));
4791
4792 cfun->machine->gp_save_rtx = m;
4793 }
4794
4795 return m;
4796 }
4797
4798 static void
4799 alpha_instantiate_decls (void)
4800 {
4801 if (cfun->machine->gp_save_rtx != NULL_RTX)
4802 instantiate_decl_rtl (cfun->machine->gp_save_rtx);
4803 }
4804
4805 static int
4806 alpha_ra_ever_killed (void)
4807 {
4808 rtx top;
4809
4810 if (!has_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, REG_RA))
4811 return (int)df_regs_ever_live_p (REG_RA);
4812
4813 push_topmost_sequence ();
4814 top = get_insns ();
4815 pop_topmost_sequence ();
4816
4817 return reg_set_between_p (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, REG_RA), top, NULL_RTX);
4818 }
4819
4820 \f
4821 /* Return the trap mode suffix applicable to the current
4822 instruction, or NULL. */
4823
4824 static const char *
4825 get_trap_mode_suffix (void)
4826 {
4827 enum attr_trap_suffix s = get_attr_trap_suffix (current_output_insn);
4828
4829 switch (s)
4830 {
4831 case TRAP_SUFFIX_NONE:
4832 return NULL;
4833
4834 case TRAP_SUFFIX_SU:
4835 if (alpha_fptm >= ALPHA_FPTM_SU)
4836 return "su";
4837 return NULL;
4838
4839 case TRAP_SUFFIX_SUI:
4840 if (alpha_fptm >= ALPHA_FPTM_SUI)
4841 return "sui";
4842 return NULL;
4843
4844 case TRAP_SUFFIX_V_SV:
4845 switch (alpha_fptm)
4846 {
4847 case ALPHA_FPTM_N:
4848 return NULL;
4849 case ALPHA_FPTM_U:
4850 return "v";
4851 case ALPHA_FPTM_SU:
4852 case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI:
4853 return "sv";
4854 default:
4855 gcc_unreachable ();
4856 }
4857
4858 case TRAP_SUFFIX_V_SV_SVI:
4859 switch (alpha_fptm)
4860 {
4861 case ALPHA_FPTM_N:
4862 return NULL;
4863 case ALPHA_FPTM_U:
4864 return "v";
4865 case ALPHA_FPTM_SU:
4866 return "sv";
4867 case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI:
4868 return "svi";
4869 default:
4870 gcc_unreachable ();
4871 }
4872 break;
4873
4874 case TRAP_SUFFIX_U_SU_SUI:
4875 switch (alpha_fptm)
4876 {
4877 case ALPHA_FPTM_N:
4878 return NULL;
4879 case ALPHA_FPTM_U:
4880 return "u";
4881 case ALPHA_FPTM_SU:
4882 return "su";
4883 case ALPHA_FPTM_SUI:
4884 return "sui";
4885 default:
4886 gcc_unreachable ();
4887 }
4888 break;
4889
4890 default:
4891 gcc_unreachable ();
4892 }
4893 gcc_unreachable ();
4894 }
4895
4896 /* Return the rounding mode suffix applicable to the current
4897 instruction, or NULL. */
4898
4899 static const char *
4900 get_round_mode_suffix (void)
4901 {
4902 enum attr_round_suffix s = get_attr_round_suffix (current_output_insn);
4903
4904 switch (s)
4905 {
4906 case ROUND_SUFFIX_NONE:
4907 return NULL;
4908 case ROUND_SUFFIX_NORMAL:
4909 switch (alpha_fprm)
4910 {
4911 case ALPHA_FPRM_NORM:
4912 return NULL;
4913 case ALPHA_FPRM_MINF:
4914 return "m";
4915 case ALPHA_FPRM_CHOP:
4916 return "c";
4917 case ALPHA_FPRM_DYN:
4918 return "d";
4919 default:
4920 gcc_unreachable ();
4921 }
4922 break;
4923
4924 case ROUND_SUFFIX_C:
4925 return "c";
4926
4927 default:
4928 gcc_unreachable ();
4929 }
4930 gcc_unreachable ();
4931 }
4932
4933 /* Locate some local-dynamic symbol still in use by this function
4934 so that we can print its name in some movdi_er_tlsldm pattern. */
4935
4936 static int
4937 get_some_local_dynamic_name_1 (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4938 {
4939 rtx x = *px;
4940
4941 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
4942 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x) == TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC)
4943 {
4944 cfun->machine->some_ld_name = XSTR (x, 0);
4945 return 1;
4946 }
4947
4948 return 0;
4949 }
4950
4951 static const char *
4952 get_some_local_dynamic_name (void)
4953 {
4954 rtx insn;
4955
4956 if (cfun->machine->some_ld_name)
4957 return cfun->machine->some_ld_name;
4958
4959 for (insn = get_insns (); insn ; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
4960 if (INSN_P (insn)
4961 && for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), get_some_local_dynamic_name_1, 0))
4962 return cfun->machine->some_ld_name;
4963
4964 gcc_unreachable ();
4965 }
4966
4967 /* Print an operand. Recognize special options, documented below. */
4968
4969 void
4970 print_operand (FILE *file, rtx x, int code)
4971 {
4972 int i;
4973
4974 switch (code)
4975 {
4976 case '~':
4977 /* Print the assembler name of the current function. */
4978 assemble_name (file, alpha_fnname);
4979 break;
4980
4981 case '&':
4982 assemble_name (file, get_some_local_dynamic_name ());
4983 break;
4984
4985 case '/':
4986 {
4987 const char *trap = get_trap_mode_suffix ();
4988 const char *round = get_round_mode_suffix ();
4989
4990 if (trap || round)
4991 fprintf (file, (TARGET_AS_SLASH_BEFORE_SUFFIX ? "/%s%s" : "%s%s"),
4992 (trap ? trap : ""), (round ? round : ""));
4993 break;
4994 }
4995
4996 case ',':
4997 /* Generates single precision instruction suffix. */
4998 fputc ((TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? 'f' : 's'), file);
4999 break;
5000
5001 case '-':
5002 /* Generates double precision instruction suffix. */
5003 fputc ((TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? 'g' : 't'), file);
5004 break;
5005
5006 case '#':
5007 if (alpha_this_literal_sequence_number == 0)
5008 alpha_this_literal_sequence_number = alpha_next_sequence_number++;
5009 fprintf (file, "%d", alpha_this_literal_sequence_number);
5010 break;
5011
5012 case '*':
5013 if (alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number == 0)
5014 alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number = alpha_next_sequence_number++;
5015 fprintf (file, "%d", alpha_this_gpdisp_sequence_number);
5016 break;
5017
5018 case 'H':
5019 if (GET_CODE (x) == HIGH)
5020 output_addr_const (file, XEXP (x, 0));
5021 else
5022 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%H value");
5023 break;
5024
5025 case 'J':
5026 {
5027 const char *lituse;
5028
5029 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLSGD_CALL)
5030 {
5031 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
5032 lituse = "lituse_tlsgd";
5033 }
5034 else if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLSLDM_CALL)
5035 {
5036 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
5037 lituse = "lituse_tlsldm";
5038 }
5039 else if (CONST_INT_P (x))
5040 lituse = "lituse_jsr";
5041 else
5042 {
5043 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%J value");
5044 break;
5045 }
5046
5047 if (x != const0_rtx)
5048 fprintf (file, "\t\t!%s!%d", lituse, (int) INTVAL (x));
5049 }
5050 break;
5051
5052 case 'j':
5053 {
5054 const char *lituse;
5055
5056 #ifdef HAVE_AS_JSRDIRECT_RELOCS
5057 lituse = "lituse_jsrdirect";
5058 #else
5059 lituse = "lituse_jsr";
5060 #endif
5061
5062 gcc_assert (INTVAL (x) != 0);
5063 fprintf (file, "\t\t!%s!%d", lituse, (int) INTVAL (x));
5064 }
5065 break;
5066 case 'r':
5067 /* If this operand is the constant zero, write it as "$31". */
5068 if (REG_P (x))
5069 fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]);
5070 else if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)))
5071 fprintf (file, "$31");
5072 else
5073 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%r value");
5074 break;
5075
5076 case 'R':
5077 /* Similar, but for floating-point. */
5078 if (REG_P (x))
5079 fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]);
5080 else if (x == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (x)))
5081 fprintf (file, "$f31");
5082 else
5083 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%R value");
5084 break;
5085
5086 case 'N':
5087 /* Write the 1's complement of a constant. */
5088 if (!CONST_INT_P (x))
5089 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%N value");
5090
5091 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, ~ INTVAL (x));
5092 break;
5093
5094 case 'P':
5095 /* Write 1 << C, for a constant C. */
5096 if (!CONST_INT_P (x))
5097 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%P value");
5098
5099 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (x));
5100 break;
5101
5102 case 'h':
5103 /* Write the high-order 16 bits of a constant, sign-extended. */
5104 if (!CONST_INT_P (x))
5105 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%h value");
5106
5107 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, INTVAL (x) >> 16);
5108 break;
5109
5110 case 'L':
5111 /* Write the low-order 16 bits of a constant, sign-extended. */
5112 if (!CONST_INT_P (x))
5113 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%L value");
5114
5115 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
5116 (INTVAL (x) & 0xffff) - 2 * (INTVAL (x) & 0x8000));
5117 break;
5118
5119 case 'm':
5120 /* Write mask for ZAP insn. */
5121 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE)
5122 {
5123 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0;
5124 HOST_WIDE_INT value;
5125
5126 value = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x);
5127 for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
5128 i++, value >>= 8)
5129 if (value & 0xff)
5130 mask |= (1 << i);
5131
5132 value = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (x);
5133 for (i = 0; i < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
5134 i++, value >>= 8)
5135 if (value & 0xff)
5136 mask |= (1 << (i + sizeof (int)));
5137
5138 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, mask & 0xff);
5139 }
5140
5141 else if (CONST_INT_P (x))
5142 {
5143 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0, value = INTVAL (x);
5144
5145 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++, value >>= 8)
5146 if (value & 0xff)
5147 mask |= (1 << i);
5148
5149 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, mask);
5150 }
5151 else
5152 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%m value");
5153 break;
5154
5155 case 'M':
5156 /* 'b', 'w', 'l', or 'q' as the value of the constant. */
5157 if (!CONST_INT_P (x)
5158 || (INTVAL (x) != 8 && INTVAL (x) != 16
5159 && INTVAL (x) != 32 && INTVAL (x) != 64))
5160 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%M value");
5161
5162 fprintf (file, "%s",
5163 (INTVAL (x) == 8 ? "b"
5164 : INTVAL (x) == 16 ? "w"
5165 : INTVAL (x) == 32 ? "l"
5166 : "q"));
5167 break;
5168
5169 case 'U':
5170 /* Similar, except do it from the mask. */
5171 if (CONST_INT_P (x))
5172 {
5173 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (x);
5174
5175 if (value == 0xff)
5176 {
5177 fputc ('b', file);
5178 break;
5179 }
5180 if (value == 0xffff)
5181 {
5182 fputc ('w', file);
5183 break;
5184 }
5185 if (value == 0xffffffff)
5186 {
5187 fputc ('l', file);
5188 break;
5189 }
5190 if (value == -1)
5191 {
5192 fputc ('q', file);
5193 break;
5194 }
5195 }
5196 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
5197 && GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
5198 && CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (x) == 0xffffffff
5199 && CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (x) == 0)
5200 {
5201 fputc ('l', file);
5202 break;
5203 }
5204 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%U value");
5205 break;
5206
5207 case 's':
5208 /* Write the constant value divided by 8. */
5209 if (!CONST_INT_P (x)
5210 || (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (x) >= 64
5211 || (INTVAL (x) & 7) != 0)
5212 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%s value");
5213
5214 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, INTVAL (x) / 8);
5215 break;
5216
5217 case 'S':
5218 /* Same, except compute (64 - c) / 8 */
5219
5220 if (!CONST_INT_P (x)
5221 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (x) >= 64
5222 && (INTVAL (x) & 7) != 8)
5223 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%s value");
5224
5225 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, (64 - INTVAL (x)) / 8);
5226 break;
5227
5228 case 'C': case 'D': case 'c': case 'd':
5229 /* Write out comparison name. */
5230 {
5231 enum rtx_code c = GET_CODE (x);
5232
5233 if (!COMPARISON_P (x))
5234 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%C value");
5235
5236 else if (code == 'D')
5237 c = reverse_condition (c);
5238 else if (code == 'c')
5239 c = swap_condition (c);
5240 else if (code == 'd')
5241 c = swap_condition (reverse_condition (c));
5242
5243 if (c == LEU)
5244 fprintf (file, "ule");
5245 else if (c == LTU)
5246 fprintf (file, "ult");
5247 else if (c == UNORDERED)
5248 fprintf (file, "un");
5249 else
5250 fprintf (file, "%s", GET_RTX_NAME (c));
5251 }
5252 break;
5253
5254 case 'E':
5255 /* Write the divide or modulus operator. */
5256 switch (GET_CODE (x))
5257 {
5258 case DIV:
5259 fprintf (file, "div%s", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q");
5260 break;
5261 case UDIV:
5262 fprintf (file, "div%su", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q");
5263 break;
5264 case MOD:
5265 fprintf (file, "rem%s", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q");
5266 break;
5267 case UMOD:
5268 fprintf (file, "rem%su", GET_MODE (x) == SImode ? "l" : "q");
5269 break;
5270 default:
5271 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%E value");
5272 break;
5273 }
5274 break;
5275
5276 case 'A':
5277 /* Write "_u" for unaligned access. */
5278 if (MEM_P (x) && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == AND)
5279 fprintf (file, "_u");
5280 break;
5281
5282 case 0:
5283 if (REG_P (x))
5284 fprintf (file, "%s", reg_names[REGNO (x)]);
5285 else if (MEM_P (x))
5286 output_address (XEXP (x, 0));
5287 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == UNSPEC)
5288 {
5289 switch (XINT (XEXP (x, 0), 1))
5290 {
5291 case UNSPEC_DTPREL:
5292 case UNSPEC_TPREL:
5293 output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0, 0));
5294 break;
5295 default:
5296 output_operand_lossage ("unknown relocation unspec");
5297 break;
5298 }
5299 }
5300 else
5301 output_addr_const (file, x);
5302 break;
5303
5304 default:
5305 output_operand_lossage ("invalid %%xn code");
5306 }
5307 }
5308
5309 void
5310 print_operand_address (FILE *file, rtx addr)
5311 {
5312 int basereg = 31;
5313 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
5314
5315 if (GET_CODE (addr) == AND)
5316 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
5317
5318 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS
5319 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (addr, 1)))
5320 {
5321 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1));
5322 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
5323 }
5324
5325 if (GET_CODE (addr) == LO_SUM)
5326 {
5327 const char *reloc16, *reloclo;
5328 rtx op1 = XEXP (addr, 1);
5329
5330 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST && GET_CODE (XEXP (op1, 0)) == UNSPEC)
5331 {
5332 op1 = XEXP (op1, 0);
5333 switch (XINT (op1, 1))
5334 {
5335 case UNSPEC_DTPREL:
5336 reloc16 = NULL;
5337 reloclo = (alpha_tls_size == 16 ? "dtprel" : "dtprello");
5338 break;
5339 case UNSPEC_TPREL:
5340 reloc16 = NULL;
5341 reloclo = (alpha_tls_size == 16 ? "tprel" : "tprello");
5342 break;
5343 default:
5344 output_operand_lossage ("unknown relocation unspec");
5345 return;
5346 }
5347
5348 output_addr_const (file, XVECEXP (op1, 0, 0));
5349 }
5350 else
5351 {
5352 reloc16 = "gprel";
5353 reloclo = "gprellow";
5354 output_addr_const (file, op1);
5355 }
5356
5357 if (offset)
5358 fprintf (file, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, offset);
5359
5360 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
5361 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
5362 {
5363 case REG:
5364 basereg = REGNO (addr);
5365 break;
5366
5367 case SUBREG:
5368 basereg = subreg_regno (addr);
5369 break;
5370
5371 default:
5372 gcc_unreachable ();
5373 }
5374
5375 fprintf (file, "($%d)\t\t!%s", basereg,
5376 (basereg == 29 ? reloc16 : reloclo));
5377 return;
5378 }
5379
5380 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
5381 {
5382 case REG:
5383 basereg = REGNO (addr);
5384 break;
5385
5386 case SUBREG:
5387 basereg = subreg_regno (addr);
5388 break;
5389
5390 case CONST_INT:
5391 offset = INTVAL (addr);
5392 break;
5393
5394 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
5395 case SYMBOL_REF:
5396 fprintf (file, "%s", XSTR (addr, 0));
5397 return;
5398
5399 case CONST:
5400 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (addr, 0)) == PLUS
5401 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
5402 fprintf (file, "%s+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
5403 XSTR (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 0), 0),
5404 INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (addr, 0), 1)));
5405 return;
5406
5407 #endif
5408 default:
5409 gcc_unreachable ();
5410 }
5411
5412 fprintf (file, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "($%d)", offset, basereg);
5413 }
5414 \f
5415 /* Emit RTL insns to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline at
5416 M_TRAMP. FNDECL is target function's decl. CHAIN_VALUE is an rtx
5417 for the static chain value for the function. */
5418
5419 static void
5420 alpha_trampoline_init (rtx m_tramp, tree fndecl, rtx chain_value)
5421 {
5422 rtx fnaddr, mem, word1, word2;
5423
5424 fnaddr = XEXP (DECL_RTL (fndecl), 0);
5425
5426 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
5427 fnaddr = convert_memory_address (Pmode, fnaddr);
5428 chain_value = convert_memory_address (Pmode, chain_value);
5429 #endif
5430
5431 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
5432 {
5433 const char *fnname;
5434 char *trname;
5435
5436 /* Construct the name of the trampoline entry point. */
5437 fnname = XSTR (fnaddr, 0);
5438 trname = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 5);
5439 strcpy (trname, fnname);
5440 strcat (trname, "..tr");
5441 fnname = ggc_alloc_string (trname, strlen (trname) + 1);
5442 word2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fnname);
5443
5444 /* Trampoline (or "bounded") procedure descriptor is constructed from
5445 the function's procedure descriptor with certain fields zeroed IAW
5446 the VMS calling standard. This is stored in the first quadword. */
5447 word1 = force_reg (DImode, gen_const_mem (DImode, fnaddr));
5448 word1 = expand_and (DImode, word1, GEN_INT (0xffff0fff0000fff0), NULL);
5449 }
5450 else
5451 {
5452 /* These 4 instructions are:
5453 ldq $1,24($27)
5454 ldq $27,16($27)
5455 jmp $31,($27),0
5456 nop
5457 We don't bother setting the HINT field of the jump; the nop
5458 is merely there for padding. */
5459 word1 = GEN_INT (0xa77b0010a43b0018);
5460 word2 = GEN_INT (0x47ff041f6bfb0000);
5461 }
5462
5463 /* Store the first two words, as computed above. */
5464 mem = adjust_address (m_tramp, DImode, 0);
5465 emit_move_insn (mem, word1);
5466 mem = adjust_address (m_tramp, DImode, 8);
5467 emit_move_insn (mem, word2);
5468
5469 /* Store function address and static chain value. */
5470 mem = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 16);
5471 emit_move_insn (mem, fnaddr);
5472 mem = adjust_address (m_tramp, Pmode, 24);
5473 emit_move_insn (mem, chain_value);
5474
5475 if (TARGET_ABI_OSF)
5476 {
5477 emit_insn (gen_imb ());
5478 #ifdef HAVE_ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5479 emit_library_call (init_one_libfunc ("__enable_execute_stack"),
5480 LCT_NORMAL, VOIDmode, 1, XEXP (m_tramp, 0), Pmode);
5481 #endif
5482 }
5483 }
5484 \f
5485 /* Determine where to put an argument to a function.
5486 Value is zero to push the argument on the stack,
5487 or a hard register in which to store the argument.
5488
5489 MODE is the argument's machine mode.
5490 TYPE is the data type of the argument (as a tree).
5491 This is null for libcalls where that information may
5492 not be available.
5493 CUM is a variable of type CUMULATIVE_ARGS which gives info about
5494 the preceding args and about the function being called.
5495 NAMED is nonzero if this argument is a named parameter
5496 (otherwise it is an extra parameter matching an ellipsis).
5497
5498 On Alpha the first 6 words of args are normally in registers
5499 and the rest are pushed. */
5500
5501 static rtx
5502 alpha_function_arg (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode,
5503 const_tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5504 {
5505 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
5506 int basereg;
5507 int num_args;
5508
5509 /* Don't get confused and pass small structures in FP registers. */
5510 if (type && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type))
5511 basereg = 16;
5512 else
5513 {
5514 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
5515 /* With alpha_split_complex_arg, we shouldn't see any raw complex
5516 values here. */
5517 gcc_assert (!COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode));
5518 #endif
5519
5520 /* Set up defaults for FP operands passed in FP registers, and
5521 integral operands passed in integer registers. */
5522 if (TARGET_FPREGS && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
5523 basereg = 32 + 16;
5524 else
5525 basereg = 16;
5526 }
5527
5528 /* ??? Irritatingly, the definition of CUMULATIVE_ARGS is different for
5529 the two platforms, so we can't avoid conditional compilation. */
5530 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
5531 {
5532 if (mode == VOIDmode)
5533 return alpha_arg_info_reg_val (*cum);
5534
5535 num_args = cum->num_args;
5536 if (num_args >= 6
5537 || targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (mode, type))
5538 return NULL_RTX;
5539 }
5540 #elif TARGET_ABI_OSF
5541 {
5542 if (*cum >= 6)
5543 return NULL_RTX;
5544 num_args = *cum;
5545
5546 /* VOID is passed as a special flag for "last argument". */
5547 if (type == void_type_node)
5548 basereg = 16;
5549 else if (targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (mode, type))
5550 return NULL_RTX;
5551 }
5552 #else
5553 #error Unhandled ABI
5554 #endif
5555
5556 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, num_args + basereg);
5557 }
5558
5559 /* Update the data in CUM to advance over an argument
5560 of mode MODE and data type TYPE.
5561 (TYPE is null for libcalls where that information may not be available.) */
5562
5563 static void
5564 alpha_function_arg_advance (cumulative_args_t cum_v, enum machine_mode mode,
5565 const_tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5566 {
5567 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
5568 bool onstack = targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (mode, type);
5569 int increment = onstack ? 6 : ALPHA_ARG_SIZE (mode, type, named);
5570
5571 #if TARGET_ABI_OSF
5572 *cum += increment;
5573 #else
5574 if (!onstack && cum->num_args < 6)
5575 cum->atypes[cum->num_args] = alpha_arg_type (mode);
5576 cum->num_args += increment;
5577 #endif
5578 }
5579
5580 static int
5581 alpha_arg_partial_bytes (cumulative_args_t cum_v,
5582 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5583 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5584 bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5585 {
5586 int words = 0;
5587 CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED = get_cumulative_args (cum_v);
5588
5589 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
5590 if (cum->num_args < 6
5591 && 6 < cum->num_args + ALPHA_ARG_SIZE (mode, type, named))
5592 words = 6 - cum->num_args;
5593 #elif TARGET_ABI_OSF
5594 if (*cum < 6 && 6 < *cum + ALPHA_ARG_SIZE (mode, type, named))
5595 words = 6 - *cum;
5596 #else
5597 #error Unhandled ABI
5598 #endif
5599
5600 return words * UNITS_PER_WORD;
5601 }
5602
5603
5604 /* Return true if TYPE must be returned in memory, instead of in registers. */
5605
5606 static bool
5607 alpha_return_in_memory (const_tree type, const_tree fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5608 {
5609 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
5610 int size;
5611
5612 if (type)
5613 {
5614 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
5615
5616 /* All aggregates are returned in memory, except on OpenVMS where
5617 records that fit 64 bits should be returned by immediate value
5618 as required by section 3.8.7.1 of the OpenVMS Calling Standard. */
5619 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
5620 && TREE_CODE (type) != ARRAY_TYPE
5621 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) int_size_in_bytes(type) <= 8)
5622 return false;
5623
5624 if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type))
5625 return true;
5626 }
5627
5628 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
5629 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
5630 {
5631 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
5632 /* Pass all float vectors in memory, like an aggregate. */
5633 return true;
5634
5635 case MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT:
5636 /* We judge complex floats on the size of their element,
5637 not the size of the whole type. */
5638 size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
5639 break;
5640
5641 case MODE_INT:
5642 case MODE_FLOAT:
5643 case MODE_COMPLEX_INT:
5644 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
5645 break;
5646
5647 default:
5648 /* ??? We get called on all sorts of random stuff from
5649 aggregate_value_p. We must return something, but it's not
5650 clear what's safe to return. Pretend it's a struct I
5651 guess. */
5652 return true;
5653 }
5654
5655 /* Otherwise types must fit in one register. */
5656 return size > UNITS_PER_WORD;
5657 }
5658
5659 /* Return true if TYPE should be passed by invisible reference. */
5660
5661 static bool
5662 alpha_pass_by_reference (cumulative_args_t ca ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5663 enum machine_mode mode,
5664 const_tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5665 bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5666 {
5667 return mode == TFmode || mode == TCmode;
5668 }
5669
5670 /* Define how to find the value returned by a function. VALTYPE is the
5671 data type of the value (as a tree). If the precise function being
5672 called is known, FUNC is its FUNCTION_DECL; otherwise, FUNC is 0.
5673 MODE is set instead of VALTYPE for libcalls.
5674
5675 On Alpha the value is found in $0 for integer functions and
5676 $f0 for floating-point functions. */
5677
5678 rtx
5679 function_value (const_tree valtype, const_tree func ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
5680 enum machine_mode mode)
5681 {
5682 unsigned int regnum, dummy ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
5683 enum mode_class mclass;
5684
5685 gcc_assert (!valtype || !alpha_return_in_memory (valtype, func));
5686
5687 if (valtype)
5688 mode = TYPE_MODE (valtype);
5689
5690 mclass = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
5691 switch (mclass)
5692 {
5693 case MODE_INT:
5694 /* Do the same thing as PROMOTE_MODE except for libcalls on VMS,
5695 where we have them returning both SImode and DImode. */
5696 if (!(TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && valtype && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (valtype)))
5697 PROMOTE_MODE (mode, dummy, valtype);
5698 /* FALLTHRU */
5699
5700 case MODE_COMPLEX_INT:
5701 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
5702 regnum = 0;
5703 break;
5704
5705 case MODE_FLOAT:
5706 regnum = 32;
5707 break;
5708
5709 case MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT:
5710 {
5711 enum machine_mode cmode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
5712
5713 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL
5714 (VOIDmode,
5715 gen_rtvec (2,
5716 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (cmode, 32),
5717 const0_rtx),
5718 gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (cmode, 33),
5719 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (cmode)))));
5720 }
5721
5722 case MODE_RANDOM:
5723 /* We should only reach here for BLKmode on VMS. */
5724 gcc_assert (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && mode == BLKmode);
5725 regnum = 0;
5726 break;
5727
5728 default:
5729 gcc_unreachable ();
5730 }
5731
5732 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, regnum);
5733 }
5734
5735 /* TCmode complex values are passed by invisible reference. We
5736 should not split these values. */
5737
5738 static bool
5739 alpha_split_complex_arg (const_tree type)
5740 {
5741 return TYPE_MODE (type) != TCmode;
5742 }
5743
5744 static tree
5745 alpha_build_builtin_va_list (void)
5746 {
5747 tree base, ofs, space, record, type_decl;
5748
5749 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
5750 return ptr_type_node;
5751
5752 record = (*lang_hooks.types.make_type) (RECORD_TYPE);
5753 type_decl = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION,
5754 TYPE_DECL, get_identifier ("__va_list_tag"), record);
5755 TYPE_STUB_DECL (record) = type_decl;
5756 TYPE_NAME (record) = type_decl;
5757
5758 /* C++? SET_IS_AGGR_TYPE (record, 1); */
5759
5760 /* Dummy field to prevent alignment warnings. */
5761 space = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION,
5762 FIELD_DECL, NULL_TREE, integer_type_node);
5763 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (space) = record;
5764 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (space) = 1;
5765 DECL_IGNORED_P (space) = 1;
5766
5767 ofs = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION,
5768 FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__offset"),
5769 integer_type_node);
5770 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (ofs) = record;
5771 DECL_CHAIN (ofs) = space;
5772 /* ??? This is a hack, __offset is marked volatile to prevent
5773 DCE that confuses stdarg optimization and results in
5774 gcc.c-torture/execute/stdarg-1.c failure. See PR 41089. */
5775 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (ofs) = 1;
5776
5777 base = build_decl (BUILTINS_LOCATION,
5778 FIELD_DECL, get_identifier ("__base"),
5779 ptr_type_node);
5780 DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (base) = record;
5781 DECL_CHAIN (base) = ofs;
5782
5783 TYPE_FIELDS (record) = base;
5784 layout_type (record);
5785
5786 va_list_gpr_counter_field = ofs;
5787 return record;
5788 }
5789
5790 #if TARGET_ABI_OSF
5791 /* Helper function for alpha_stdarg_optimize_hook. Skip over casts
5792 and constant additions. */
5793
5794 static gimple
5795 va_list_skip_additions (tree lhs)
5796 {
5797 gimple stmt;
5798
5799 for (;;)
5800 {
5801 enum tree_code code;
5802
5803 stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (lhs);
5804
5805 if (gimple_code (stmt) == GIMPLE_PHI)
5806 return stmt;
5807
5808 if (!is_gimple_assign (stmt)
5809 || gimple_assign_lhs (stmt) != lhs)
5810 return NULL;
5811
5812 if (TREE_CODE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt)) != SSA_NAME)
5813 return stmt;
5814 code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
5815 if (!CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
5816 && ((code != PLUS_EXPR && code != POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
5817 || TREE_CODE (gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt)) != INTEGER_CST
5818 || !host_integerp (gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt), 1)))
5819 return stmt;
5820
5821 lhs = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
5822 }
5823 }
5824
5825 /* Check if LHS = RHS statement is
5826 LHS = *(ap.__base + ap.__offset + cst)
5827 or
5828 LHS = *(ap.__base
5829 + ((ap.__offset + cst <= 47)
5830 ? ap.__offset + cst - 48 : ap.__offset + cst) + cst2).
5831 If the former, indicate that GPR registers are needed,
5832 if the latter, indicate that FPR registers are needed.
5833
5834 Also look for LHS = (*ptr).field, where ptr is one of the forms
5835 listed above.
5836
5837 On alpha, cfun->va_list_gpr_size is used as size of the needed
5838 regs and cfun->va_list_fpr_size is a bitmask, bit 0 set if GPR
5839 registers are needed and bit 1 set if FPR registers are needed.
5840 Return true if va_list references should not be scanned for the
5841 current statement. */
5842
5843 static bool
5844 alpha_stdarg_optimize_hook (struct stdarg_info *si, const_gimple stmt)
5845 {
5846 tree base, offset, rhs;
5847 int offset_arg = 1;
5848 gimple base_stmt;
5849
5850 if (get_gimple_rhs_class (gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt))
5851 != GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS)
5852 return false;
5853
5854 rhs = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
5855 while (handled_component_p (rhs))
5856 rhs = TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0);
5857 if (TREE_CODE (rhs) != MEM_REF
5858 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0)) != SSA_NAME)
5859 return false;
5860
5861 stmt = va_list_skip_additions (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0));
5862 if (stmt == NULL
5863 || !is_gimple_assign (stmt)
5864 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt) != POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
5865 return false;
5866
5867 base = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
5868 if (TREE_CODE (base) == SSA_NAME)
5869 {
5870 base_stmt = va_list_skip_additions (base);
5871 if (base_stmt
5872 && is_gimple_assign (base_stmt)
5873 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (base_stmt) == COMPONENT_REF)
5874 base = gimple_assign_rhs1 (base_stmt);
5875 }
5876
5877 if (TREE_CODE (base) != COMPONENT_REF
5878 || TREE_OPERAND (base, 1) != TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node))
5879 {
5880 base = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
5881 if (TREE_CODE (base) == SSA_NAME)
5882 {
5883 base_stmt = va_list_skip_additions (base);
5884 if (base_stmt
5885 && is_gimple_assign (base_stmt)
5886 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (base_stmt) == COMPONENT_REF)
5887 base = gimple_assign_rhs1 (base_stmt);
5888 }
5889
5890 if (TREE_CODE (base) != COMPONENT_REF
5891 || TREE_OPERAND (base, 1) != TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node))
5892 return false;
5893
5894 offset_arg = 0;
5895 }
5896
5897 base = get_base_address (base);
5898 if (TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
5899 || !bitmap_bit_p (si->va_list_vars, DECL_UID (base)))
5900 return false;
5901
5902 offset = gimple_op (stmt, 1 + offset_arg);
5903 if (TREE_CODE (offset) == SSA_NAME)
5904 {
5905 gimple offset_stmt = va_list_skip_additions (offset);
5906
5907 if (offset_stmt
5908 && gimple_code (offset_stmt) == GIMPLE_PHI)
5909 {
5910 HOST_WIDE_INT sub;
5911 gimple arg1_stmt, arg2_stmt;
5912 tree arg1, arg2;
5913 enum tree_code code1, code2;
5914
5915 if (gimple_phi_num_args (offset_stmt) != 2)
5916 goto escapes;
5917
5918 arg1_stmt
5919 = va_list_skip_additions (gimple_phi_arg_def (offset_stmt, 0));
5920 arg2_stmt
5921 = va_list_skip_additions (gimple_phi_arg_def (offset_stmt, 1));
5922 if (arg1_stmt == NULL
5923 || !is_gimple_assign (arg1_stmt)
5924 || arg2_stmt == NULL
5925 || !is_gimple_assign (arg2_stmt))
5926 goto escapes;
5927
5928 code1 = gimple_assign_rhs_code (arg1_stmt);
5929 code2 = gimple_assign_rhs_code (arg2_stmt);
5930 if (code1 == COMPONENT_REF
5931 && (code2 == MINUS_EXPR || code2 == PLUS_EXPR))
5932 /* Do nothing. */;
5933 else if (code2 == COMPONENT_REF
5934 && (code1 == MINUS_EXPR || code1 == PLUS_EXPR))
5935 {
5936 gimple tem = arg1_stmt;
5937 code2 = code1;
5938 arg1_stmt = arg2_stmt;
5939 arg2_stmt = tem;
5940 }
5941 else
5942 goto escapes;
5943
5944 if (!host_integerp (gimple_assign_rhs2 (arg2_stmt), 0))
5945 goto escapes;
5946
5947 sub = tree_low_cst (gimple_assign_rhs2 (arg2_stmt), 0);
5948 if (code2 == MINUS_EXPR)
5949 sub = -sub;
5950 if (sub < -48 || sub > -32)
5951 goto escapes;
5952
5953 arg1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (arg1_stmt);
5954 arg2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (arg2_stmt);
5955 if (TREE_CODE (arg2) == SSA_NAME)
5956 {
5957 arg2_stmt = va_list_skip_additions (arg2);
5958 if (arg2_stmt == NULL
5959 || !is_gimple_assign (arg2_stmt)
5960 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (arg2_stmt) != COMPONENT_REF)
5961 goto escapes;
5962 arg2 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (arg2_stmt);
5963 }
5964 if (arg1 != arg2)
5965 goto escapes;
5966
5967 if (TREE_CODE (arg1) != COMPONENT_REF
5968 || TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 1) != va_list_gpr_counter_field
5969 || get_base_address (arg1) != base)
5970 goto escapes;
5971
5972 /* Need floating point regs. */
5973 cfun->va_list_fpr_size |= 2;
5974 return false;
5975 }
5976 if (offset_stmt
5977 && is_gimple_assign (offset_stmt)
5978 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (offset_stmt) == COMPONENT_REF)
5979 offset = gimple_assign_rhs1 (offset_stmt);
5980 }
5981 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != COMPONENT_REF
5982 || TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1) != va_list_gpr_counter_field
5983 || get_base_address (offset) != base)
5984 goto escapes;
5985 else
5986 /* Need general regs. */
5987 cfun->va_list_fpr_size |= 1;
5988 return false;
5989
5990 escapes:
5991 si->va_list_escapes = true;
5992 return false;
5993 }
5994 #endif
5995
5996 /* Perform any needed actions needed for a function that is receiving a
5997 variable number of arguments. */
5998
5999 static void
6000 alpha_setup_incoming_varargs (cumulative_args_t pcum, enum machine_mode mode,
6001 tree type, int *pretend_size, int no_rtl)
6002 {
6003 CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum = *get_cumulative_args (pcum);
6004
6005 /* Skip the current argument. */
6006 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (pack_cumulative_args (&cum), mode, type,
6007 true);
6008
6009 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
6010 /* For VMS, we allocate space for all 6 arg registers plus a count.
6011
6012 However, if NO registers need to be saved, don't allocate any space.
6013 This is not only because we won't need the space, but because AP
6014 includes the current_pretend_args_size and we don't want to mess up
6015 any ap-relative addresses already made. */
6016 if (cum.num_args < 6)
6017 {
6018 if (!no_rtl)
6019 {
6020 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 1), virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
6021 emit_insn (gen_arg_home ());
6022 }
6023 *pretend_size = 7 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
6024 }
6025 #else
6026 /* On OSF/1 and friends, we allocate space for all 12 arg registers, but
6027 only push those that are remaining. However, if NO registers need to
6028 be saved, don't allocate any space. This is not only because we won't
6029 need the space, but because AP includes the current_pretend_args_size
6030 and we don't want to mess up any ap-relative addresses already made.
6031
6032 If we are not to use the floating-point registers, save the integer
6033 registers where we would put the floating-point registers. This is
6034 not the most efficient way to implement varargs with just one register
6035 class, but it isn't worth doing anything more efficient in this rare
6036 case. */
6037 if (cum >= 6)
6038 return;
6039
6040 if (!no_rtl)
6041 {
6042 int count;
6043 alias_set_type set = get_varargs_alias_set ();
6044 rtx tmp;
6045
6046 count = cfun->va_list_gpr_size / UNITS_PER_WORD;
6047 if (count > 6 - cum)
6048 count = 6 - cum;
6049
6050 /* Detect whether integer registers or floating-point registers
6051 are needed by the detected va_arg statements. See above for
6052 how these values are computed. Note that the "escape" value
6053 is VA_LIST_MAX_FPR_SIZE, which is 255, which has both of
6054 these bits set. */
6055 gcc_assert ((VA_LIST_MAX_FPR_SIZE & 3) == 3);
6056
6057 if (cfun->va_list_fpr_size & 1)
6058 {
6059 tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode,
6060 plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
6061 (cum + 6) * UNITS_PER_WORD));
6062 MEM_NOTRAP_P (tmp) = 1;
6063 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, set);
6064 move_block_from_reg (16 + cum, tmp, count);
6065 }
6066
6067 if (cfun->va_list_fpr_size & 2)
6068 {
6069 tmp = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode,
6070 plus_constant (virtual_incoming_args_rtx,
6071 cum * UNITS_PER_WORD));
6072 MEM_NOTRAP_P (tmp) = 1;
6073 set_mem_alias_set (tmp, set);
6074 move_block_from_reg (16 + cum + TARGET_FPREGS*32, tmp, count);
6075 }
6076 }
6077 *pretend_size = 12 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
6078 #endif
6079 }
6080
6081 static void
6082 alpha_va_start (tree valist, rtx nextarg ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6083 {
6084 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6085 tree t, offset_field, base_field;
6086
6087 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (valist)) == ERROR_MARK)
6088 return;
6089
6090 /* For Unix, TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS moves the starting address base
6091 up by 48, storing fp arg registers in the first 48 bytes, and the
6092 integer arg registers in the next 48 bytes. This is only done,
6093 however, if any integer registers need to be stored.
6094
6095 If no integer registers need be stored, then we must subtract 48
6096 in order to account for the integer arg registers which are counted
6097 in argsize above, but which are not actually stored on the stack.
6098 Must further be careful here about structures straddling the last
6099 integer argument register; that futzes with pretend_args_size,
6100 which changes the meaning of AP. */
6101
6102 if (NUM_ARGS < 6)
6103 offset = TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS ? UNITS_PER_WORD : 6 * UNITS_PER_WORD;
6104 else
6105 offset = -6 * UNITS_PER_WORD + crtl->args.pretend_args_size;
6106
6107 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
6108 {
6109 t = make_tree (ptr_type_node, virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
6110 t = fold_build_pointer_plus_hwi (t, offset + NUM_ARGS * UNITS_PER_WORD);
6111 t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (valist), valist, t);
6112 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
6113 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6114 }
6115 else
6116 {
6117 base_field = TYPE_FIELDS (TREE_TYPE (valist));
6118 offset_field = DECL_CHAIN (base_field);
6119
6120 base_field = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (base_field),
6121 valist, base_field, NULL_TREE);
6122 offset_field = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (offset_field),
6123 valist, offset_field, NULL_TREE);
6124
6125 t = make_tree (ptr_type_node, virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
6126 t = fold_build_pointer_plus_hwi (t, offset);
6127 t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base_field), base_field, t);
6128 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
6129 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6130
6131 t = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, NUM_ARGS * UNITS_PER_WORD);
6132 t = build2 (MODIFY_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset_field), offset_field, t);
6133 TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (t) = 1;
6134 expand_expr (t, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6135 }
6136 }
6137
6138 static tree
6139 alpha_gimplify_va_arg_1 (tree type, tree base, tree offset,
6140 gimple_seq *pre_p)
6141 {
6142 tree type_size, ptr_type, addend, t, addr;
6143 gimple_seq internal_post;
6144
6145 /* If the type could not be passed in registers, skip the block
6146 reserved for the registers. */
6147 if (targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack (TYPE_MODE (type), type))
6148 {
6149 t = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (offset), 6*8);
6150 gimplify_assign (offset,
6151 build2 (MAX_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset), offset, t),
6152 pre_p);
6153 }
6154
6155 addend = offset;
6156 ptr_type = build_pointer_type_for_mode (type, ptr_mode, true);
6157
6158 if (TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
6159 {
6160 tree real_part, imag_part, real_temp;
6161
6162 real_part = alpha_gimplify_va_arg_1 (TREE_TYPE (type), base,
6163 offset, pre_p);
6164
6165 /* Copy the value into a new temporary, lest the formal temporary
6166 be reused out from under us. */
6167 real_temp = get_initialized_tmp_var (real_part, pre_p, NULL);
6168
6169 imag_part = alpha_gimplify_va_arg_1 (TREE_TYPE (type), base,
6170 offset, pre_p);
6171
6172 return build2 (COMPLEX_EXPR, type, real_temp, imag_part);
6173 }
6174 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == REAL_TYPE)
6175 {
6176 tree fpaddend, cond, fourtyeight;
6177
6178 fourtyeight = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (addend), 6*8);
6179 fpaddend = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (addend),
6180 addend, fourtyeight);
6181 cond = fold_build2 (LT_EXPR, boolean_type_node, addend, fourtyeight);
6182 addend = fold_build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (addend), cond,
6183 fpaddend, addend);
6184 }
6185
6186 /* Build the final address and force that value into a temporary. */
6187 addr = fold_build_pointer_plus (fold_convert (ptr_type, base), addend);
6188 internal_post = NULL;
6189 gimplify_expr (&addr, pre_p, &internal_post, is_gimple_val, fb_rvalue);
6190 gimple_seq_add_seq (pre_p, internal_post);
6191
6192 /* Update the offset field. */
6193 type_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
6194 if (type_size == NULL || TREE_OVERFLOW (type_size))
6195 t = size_zero_node;
6196 else
6197 {
6198 t = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, type_size, size_int (7));
6199 t = size_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, t, size_int (8));
6200 t = size_binop (MULT_EXPR, t, size_int (8));
6201 }
6202 t = fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (offset), t);
6203 gimplify_assign (offset, build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset), offset, t),
6204 pre_p);
6205
6206 return build_va_arg_indirect_ref (addr);
6207 }
6208
6209 static tree
6210 alpha_gimplify_va_arg (tree valist, tree type, gimple_seq *pre_p,
6211 gimple_seq *post_p)
6212 {
6213 tree offset_field, base_field, offset, base, t, r;
6214 bool indirect;
6215
6216 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
6217 return std_gimplify_va_arg_expr (valist, type, pre_p, post_p);
6218
6219 base_field = TYPE_FIELDS (va_list_type_node);
6220 offset_field = DECL_CHAIN (base_field);
6221 base_field = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (base_field),
6222 valist, base_field, NULL_TREE);
6223 offset_field = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (offset_field),
6224 valist, offset_field, NULL_TREE);
6225
6226 /* Pull the fields of the structure out into temporaries. Since we never
6227 modify the base field, we can use a formal temporary. Sign-extend the
6228 offset field so that it's the proper width for pointer arithmetic. */
6229 base = get_formal_tmp_var (base_field, pre_p);
6230
6231 t = fold_convert (build_nonstandard_integer_type (64, 0), offset_field);
6232 offset = get_initialized_tmp_var (t, pre_p, NULL);
6233
6234 indirect = pass_by_reference (NULL, TYPE_MODE (type), type, false);
6235 if (indirect)
6236 type = build_pointer_type_for_mode (type, ptr_mode, true);
6237
6238 /* Find the value. Note that this will be a stable indirection, or
6239 a composite of stable indirections in the case of complex. */
6240 r = alpha_gimplify_va_arg_1 (type, base, offset, pre_p);
6241
6242 /* Stuff the offset temporary back into its field. */
6243 gimplify_assign (unshare_expr (offset_field),
6244 fold_convert (TREE_TYPE (offset_field), offset), pre_p);
6245
6246 if (indirect)
6247 r = build_va_arg_indirect_ref (r);
6248
6249 return r;
6250 }
6251 \f
6252 /* Builtins. */
6253
6254 enum alpha_builtin
6255 {
6256 ALPHA_BUILTIN_CMPBGE,
6257 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTBL,
6258 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWL,
6259 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLL,
6260 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQL,
6261 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWH,
6262 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLH,
6263 ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQH,
6264 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSBL,
6265 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWL,
6266 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLL,
6267 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQL,
6268 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWH,
6269 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLH,
6270 ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQH,
6271 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKBL,
6272 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWL,
6273 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLL,
6274 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQL,
6275 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWH,
6276 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLH,
6277 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQH,
6278 ALPHA_BUILTIN_UMULH,
6279 ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAP,
6280 ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAPNOT,
6281 ALPHA_BUILTIN_AMASK,
6282 ALPHA_BUILTIN_IMPLVER,
6283 ALPHA_BUILTIN_RPCC,
6284 ALPHA_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER,
6285 ALPHA_BUILTIN_SET_THREAD_POINTER,
6286 ALPHA_BUILTIN_ESTABLISH_VMS_CONDITION_HANDLER,
6287 ALPHA_BUILTIN_REVERT_VMS_CONDITION_HANDLER,
6288
6289 /* TARGET_MAX */
6290 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUB8,
6291 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSB8,
6292 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUW4,
6293 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSW4,
6294 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUB8,
6295 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSB8,
6296 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUW4,
6297 ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSW4,
6298 ALPHA_BUILTIN_PERR,
6299 ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKLB,
6300 ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKWB,
6301 ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBL,
6302 ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBW,
6303
6304 /* TARGET_CIX */
6305 ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTTZ,
6306 ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTLZ,
6307 ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTPOP,
6308
6309 ALPHA_BUILTIN_max
6310 };
6311
6312 static enum insn_code const code_for_builtin[ALPHA_BUILTIN_max] = {
6313 CODE_FOR_builtin_cmpbge,
6314 CODE_FOR_extbl,
6315 CODE_FOR_extwl,
6316 CODE_FOR_extll,
6317 CODE_FOR_extql,
6318 CODE_FOR_extwh,
6319 CODE_FOR_extlh,
6320 CODE_FOR_extqh,
6321 CODE_FOR_builtin_insbl,
6322 CODE_FOR_builtin_inswl,
6323 CODE_FOR_builtin_insll,
6324 CODE_FOR_insql,
6325 CODE_FOR_inswh,
6326 CODE_FOR_inslh,
6327 CODE_FOR_insqh,
6328 CODE_FOR_mskbl,
6329 CODE_FOR_mskwl,
6330 CODE_FOR_mskll,
6331 CODE_FOR_mskql,
6332 CODE_FOR_mskwh,
6333 CODE_FOR_msklh,
6334 CODE_FOR_mskqh,
6335 CODE_FOR_umuldi3_highpart,
6336 CODE_FOR_builtin_zap,
6337 CODE_FOR_builtin_zapnot,
6338 CODE_FOR_builtin_amask,
6339 CODE_FOR_builtin_implver,
6340 CODE_FOR_builtin_rpcc,
6341 CODE_FOR_load_tp,
6342 CODE_FOR_set_tp,
6343 CODE_FOR_builtin_establish_vms_condition_handler,
6344 CODE_FOR_builtin_revert_vms_condition_handler,
6345
6346 /* TARGET_MAX */
6347 CODE_FOR_builtin_minub8,
6348 CODE_FOR_builtin_minsb8,
6349 CODE_FOR_builtin_minuw4,
6350 CODE_FOR_builtin_minsw4,
6351 CODE_FOR_builtin_maxub8,
6352 CODE_FOR_builtin_maxsb8,
6353 CODE_FOR_builtin_maxuw4,
6354 CODE_FOR_builtin_maxsw4,
6355 CODE_FOR_builtin_perr,
6356 CODE_FOR_builtin_pklb,
6357 CODE_FOR_builtin_pkwb,
6358 CODE_FOR_builtin_unpkbl,
6359 CODE_FOR_builtin_unpkbw,
6360
6361 /* TARGET_CIX */
6362 CODE_FOR_ctzdi2,
6363 CODE_FOR_clzdi2,
6364 CODE_FOR_popcountdi2
6365 };
6366
6367 struct alpha_builtin_def
6368 {
6369 const char *name;
6370 enum alpha_builtin code;
6371 unsigned int target_mask;
6372 bool is_const;
6373 };
6374
6375 static struct alpha_builtin_def const zero_arg_builtins[] = {
6376 { "__builtin_alpha_implver", ALPHA_BUILTIN_IMPLVER, 0, true },
6377 { "__builtin_alpha_rpcc", ALPHA_BUILTIN_RPCC, 0, false }
6378 };
6379
6380 static struct alpha_builtin_def const one_arg_builtins[] = {
6381 { "__builtin_alpha_amask", ALPHA_BUILTIN_AMASK, 0, true },
6382 { "__builtin_alpha_pklb", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKLB, MASK_MAX, true },
6383 { "__builtin_alpha_pkwb", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKWB, MASK_MAX, true },
6384 { "__builtin_alpha_unpkbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBL, MASK_MAX, true },
6385 { "__builtin_alpha_unpkbw", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBW, MASK_MAX, true },
6386 { "__builtin_alpha_cttz", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTTZ, MASK_CIX, true },
6387 { "__builtin_alpha_ctlz", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTLZ, MASK_CIX, true },
6388 { "__builtin_alpha_ctpop", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTPOP, MASK_CIX, true }
6389 };
6390
6391 static struct alpha_builtin_def const two_arg_builtins[] = {
6392 { "__builtin_alpha_cmpbge", ALPHA_BUILTIN_CMPBGE, 0, true },
6393 { "__builtin_alpha_extbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTBL, 0, true },
6394 { "__builtin_alpha_extwl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWL, 0, true },
6395 { "__builtin_alpha_extll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLL, 0, true },
6396 { "__builtin_alpha_extql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQL, 0, true },
6397 { "__builtin_alpha_extwh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWH, 0, true },
6398 { "__builtin_alpha_extlh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLH, 0, true },
6399 { "__builtin_alpha_extqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQH, 0, true },
6400 { "__builtin_alpha_insbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSBL, 0, true },
6401 { "__builtin_alpha_inswl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWL, 0, true },
6402 { "__builtin_alpha_insll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLL, 0, true },
6403 { "__builtin_alpha_insql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQL, 0, true },
6404 { "__builtin_alpha_inswh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWH, 0, true },
6405 { "__builtin_alpha_inslh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLH, 0, true },
6406 { "__builtin_alpha_insqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQH, 0, true },
6407 { "__builtin_alpha_mskbl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKBL, 0, true },
6408 { "__builtin_alpha_mskwl", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWL, 0, true },
6409 { "__builtin_alpha_mskll", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLL, 0, true },
6410 { "__builtin_alpha_mskql", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQL, 0, true },
6411 { "__builtin_alpha_mskwh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWH, 0, true },
6412 { "__builtin_alpha_msklh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLH, 0, true },
6413 { "__builtin_alpha_mskqh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQH, 0, true },
6414 { "__builtin_alpha_umulh", ALPHA_BUILTIN_UMULH, 0, true },
6415 { "__builtin_alpha_zap", ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAP, 0, true },
6416 { "__builtin_alpha_zapnot", ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAPNOT, 0, true },
6417 { "__builtin_alpha_minub8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUB8, MASK_MAX, true },
6418 { "__builtin_alpha_minsb8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSB8, MASK_MAX, true },
6419 { "__builtin_alpha_minuw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUW4, MASK_MAX, true },
6420 { "__builtin_alpha_minsw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSW4, MASK_MAX, true },
6421 { "__builtin_alpha_maxub8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUB8, MASK_MAX, true },
6422 { "__builtin_alpha_maxsb8", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSB8, MASK_MAX, true },
6423 { "__builtin_alpha_maxuw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUW4, MASK_MAX, true },
6424 { "__builtin_alpha_maxsw4", ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSW4, MASK_MAX, true },
6425 { "__builtin_alpha_perr", ALPHA_BUILTIN_PERR, MASK_MAX, true }
6426 };
6427
6428 static GTY(()) tree alpha_v8qi_u;
6429 static GTY(()) tree alpha_v8qi_s;
6430 static GTY(()) tree alpha_v4hi_u;
6431 static GTY(()) tree alpha_v4hi_s;
6432
6433 static GTY(()) tree alpha_builtins[(int) ALPHA_BUILTIN_max];
6434
6435 /* Return the alpha builtin for CODE. */
6436
6437 static tree
6438 alpha_builtin_decl (unsigned code, bool initialize_p ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6439 {
6440 if (code >= ALPHA_BUILTIN_max)
6441 return error_mark_node;
6442 return alpha_builtins[code];
6443 }
6444
6445 /* Helper function of alpha_init_builtins. Add the built-in specified
6446 by NAME, TYPE, CODE, and ECF. */
6447
6448 static void
6449 alpha_builtin_function (const char *name, tree ftype,
6450 enum alpha_builtin code, unsigned ecf)
6451 {
6452 tree decl = add_builtin_function (name, ftype, (int) code,
6453 BUILT_IN_MD, NULL, NULL_TREE);
6454
6455 if (ecf & ECF_CONST)
6456 TREE_READONLY (decl) = 1;
6457 if (ecf & ECF_NOTHROW)
6458 TREE_NOTHROW (decl) = 1;
6459
6460 alpha_builtins [(int) code] = decl;
6461 }
6462
6463 /* Helper function of alpha_init_builtins. Add the COUNT built-in
6464 functions pointed to by P, with function type FTYPE. */
6465
6466 static void
6467 alpha_add_builtins (const struct alpha_builtin_def *p, size_t count,
6468 tree ftype)
6469 {
6470 size_t i;
6471
6472 for (i = 0; i < count; ++i, ++p)
6473 if ((target_flags & p->target_mask) == p->target_mask)
6474 alpha_builtin_function (p->name, ftype, p->code,
6475 (p->is_const ? ECF_CONST : 0) | ECF_NOTHROW);
6476 }
6477
6478 static void
6479 alpha_init_builtins (void)
6480 {
6481 tree dimode_integer_type_node;
6482 tree ftype;
6483
6484 dimode_integer_type_node = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (DImode, 0);
6485
6486 ftype = build_function_type_list (dimode_integer_type_node, NULL_TREE);
6487 alpha_add_builtins (zero_arg_builtins, ARRAY_SIZE (zero_arg_builtins),
6488 ftype);
6489
6490 ftype = build_function_type_list (dimode_integer_type_node,
6491 dimode_integer_type_node, NULL_TREE);
6492 alpha_add_builtins (one_arg_builtins, ARRAY_SIZE (one_arg_builtins),
6493 ftype);
6494
6495 ftype = build_function_type_list (dimode_integer_type_node,
6496 dimode_integer_type_node,
6497 dimode_integer_type_node, NULL_TREE);
6498 alpha_add_builtins (two_arg_builtins, ARRAY_SIZE (two_arg_builtins),
6499 ftype);
6500
6501 ftype = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
6502 alpha_builtin_function ("__builtin_thread_pointer", ftype,
6503 ALPHA_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER, ECF_NOTHROW);
6504
6505 ftype = build_function_type_list (void_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
6506 alpha_builtin_function ("__builtin_set_thread_pointer", ftype,
6507 ALPHA_BUILTIN_SET_THREAD_POINTER, ECF_NOTHROW);
6508
6509 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
6510 {
6511 ftype = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
6512 NULL_TREE);
6513 alpha_builtin_function ("__builtin_establish_vms_condition_handler",
6514 ftype,
6515 ALPHA_BUILTIN_ESTABLISH_VMS_CONDITION_HANDLER,
6516 0);
6517
6518 ftype = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, void_type_node,
6519 NULL_TREE);
6520 alpha_builtin_function ("__builtin_revert_vms_condition_handler", ftype,
6521 ALPHA_BUILTIN_REVERT_VMS_CONDITION_HANDLER, 0);
6522
6523 vms_patch_builtins ();
6524 }
6525
6526 alpha_v8qi_u = build_vector_type (unsigned_intQI_type_node, 8);
6527 alpha_v8qi_s = build_vector_type (intQI_type_node, 8);
6528 alpha_v4hi_u = build_vector_type (unsigned_intHI_type_node, 4);
6529 alpha_v4hi_s = build_vector_type (intHI_type_node, 4);
6530 }
6531
6532 /* Expand an expression EXP that calls a built-in function,
6533 with result going to TARGET if that's convenient
6534 (and in mode MODE if that's convenient).
6535 SUBTARGET may be used as the target for computing one of EXP's operands.
6536 IGNORE is nonzero if the value is to be ignored. */
6537
6538 static rtx
6539 alpha_expand_builtin (tree exp, rtx target,
6540 rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6541 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
6542 int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6543 {
6544 #define MAX_ARGS 2
6545
6546 tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (CALL_EXPR_FN (exp), 0);
6547 unsigned int fcode = DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
6548 tree arg;
6549 call_expr_arg_iterator iter;
6550 enum insn_code icode;
6551 rtx op[MAX_ARGS], pat;
6552 int arity;
6553 bool nonvoid;
6554
6555 if (fcode >= ALPHA_BUILTIN_max)
6556 internal_error ("bad builtin fcode");
6557 icode = code_for_builtin[fcode];
6558 if (icode == 0)
6559 internal_error ("bad builtin fcode");
6560
6561 nonvoid = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)) != void_type_node;
6562
6563 arity = 0;
6564 FOR_EACH_CALL_EXPR_ARG (arg, iter, exp)
6565 {
6566 const struct insn_operand_data *insn_op;
6567
6568 if (arg == error_mark_node)
6569 return NULL_RTX;
6570 if (arity > MAX_ARGS)
6571 return NULL_RTX;
6572
6573 insn_op = &insn_data[icode].operand[arity + nonvoid];
6574
6575 op[arity] = expand_expr (arg, NULL_RTX, insn_op->mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6576
6577 if (!(*insn_op->predicate) (op[arity], insn_op->mode))
6578 op[arity] = copy_to_mode_reg (insn_op->mode, op[arity]);
6579 arity++;
6580 }
6581
6582 if (nonvoid)
6583 {
6584 enum machine_mode tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
6585 if (!target
6586 || GET_MODE (target) != tmode
6587 || !(*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode))
6588 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
6589 }
6590
6591 switch (arity)
6592 {
6593 case 0:
6594 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target);
6595 break;
6596 case 1:
6597 if (nonvoid)
6598 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op[0]);
6599 else
6600 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (op[0]);
6601 break;
6602 case 2:
6603 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op[0], op[1]);
6604 break;
6605 default:
6606 gcc_unreachable ();
6607 }
6608 if (!pat)
6609 return NULL_RTX;
6610 emit_insn (pat);
6611
6612 if (nonvoid)
6613 return target;
6614 else
6615 return const0_rtx;
6616 }
6617
6618
6619 /* Several bits below assume HWI >= 64 bits. This should be enforced
6620 by config.gcc. */
6621 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT < 64
6622 # error "HOST_WIDE_INT too small"
6623 #endif
6624
6625 /* Fold the builtin for the CMPBGE instruction. This is a vector comparison
6626 with an 8-bit output vector. OPINT contains the integer operands; bit N
6627 of OP_CONST is set if OPINT[N] is valid. */
6628
6629 static tree
6630 alpha_fold_builtin_cmpbge (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6631 {
6632 if (op_const == 3)
6633 {
6634 int i, val;
6635 for (i = 0, val = 0; i < 8; ++i)
6636 {
6637 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c0 = (opint[0] >> (i * 8)) & 0xff;
6638 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c1 = (opint[1] >> (i * 8)) & 0xff;
6639 if (c0 >= c1)
6640 val |= 1 << i;
6641 }
6642 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, val);
6643 }
6644 else if (op_const == 2 && opint[1] == 0)
6645 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, 0xff);
6646 return NULL;
6647 }
6648
6649 /* Fold the builtin for the ZAPNOT instruction. This is essentially a
6650 specialized form of an AND operation. Other byte manipulation instructions
6651 are defined in terms of this instruction, so this is also used as a
6652 subroutine for other builtins.
6653
6654 OP contains the tree operands; OPINT contains the extracted integer values.
6655 Bit N of OP_CONST it set if OPINT[N] is valid. OP may be null if only
6656 OPINT may be considered. */
6657
6658 static tree
6659 alpha_fold_builtin_zapnot (tree *op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[],
6660 long op_const)
6661 {
6662 if (op_const & 2)
6663 {
6664 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0;
6665 int i;
6666
6667 for (i = 0; i < 8; ++i)
6668 if ((opint[1] >> i) & 1)
6669 mask |= (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)0xff << (i * 8);
6670
6671 if (op_const & 1)
6672 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, opint[0] & mask);
6673
6674 if (op)
6675 return fold_build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, long_integer_type_node, op[0],
6676 build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, mask));
6677 }
6678 else if ((op_const & 1) && opint[0] == 0)
6679 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, 0);
6680 return NULL;
6681 }
6682
6683 /* Fold the builtins for the EXT family of instructions. */
6684
6685 static tree
6686 alpha_fold_builtin_extxx (tree op[], unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[],
6687 long op_const, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytemask,
6688 bool is_high)
6689 {
6690 long zap_const = 2;
6691 tree *zap_op = NULL;
6692
6693 if (op_const & 2)
6694 {
6695 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT loc;
6696
6697 loc = opint[1] & 7;
6698 loc *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
6699
6700 if (loc != 0)
6701 {
6702 if (op_const & 1)
6703 {
6704 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp = opint[0];
6705 if (is_high)
6706 temp <<= loc;
6707 else
6708 temp >>= loc;
6709 opint[0] = temp;
6710 zap_const = 3;
6711 }
6712 }
6713 else
6714 zap_op = op;
6715 }
6716
6717 opint[1] = bytemask;
6718 return alpha_fold_builtin_zapnot (zap_op, opint, zap_const);
6719 }
6720
6721 /* Fold the builtins for the INS family of instructions. */
6722
6723 static tree
6724 alpha_fold_builtin_insxx (tree op[], unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[],
6725 long op_const, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytemask,
6726 bool is_high)
6727 {
6728 if ((op_const & 1) && opint[0] == 0)
6729 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, 0);
6730
6731 if (op_const & 2)
6732 {
6733 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp, loc, byteloc;
6734 tree *zap_op = NULL;
6735
6736 loc = opint[1] & 7;
6737 bytemask <<= loc;
6738
6739 temp = opint[0];
6740 if (is_high)
6741 {
6742 byteloc = (64 - (loc * 8)) & 0x3f;
6743 if (byteloc == 0)
6744 zap_op = op;
6745 else
6746 temp >>= byteloc;
6747 bytemask >>= 8;
6748 }
6749 else
6750 {
6751 byteloc = loc * 8;
6752 if (byteloc == 0)
6753 zap_op = op;
6754 else
6755 temp <<= byteloc;
6756 }
6757
6758 opint[0] = temp;
6759 opint[1] = bytemask;
6760 return alpha_fold_builtin_zapnot (zap_op, opint, op_const);
6761 }
6762
6763 return NULL;
6764 }
6765
6766 static tree
6767 alpha_fold_builtin_mskxx (tree op[], unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[],
6768 long op_const, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytemask,
6769 bool is_high)
6770 {
6771 if (op_const & 2)
6772 {
6773 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT loc;
6774
6775 loc = opint[1] & 7;
6776 bytemask <<= loc;
6777
6778 if (is_high)
6779 bytemask >>= 8;
6780
6781 opint[1] = bytemask ^ 0xff;
6782 }
6783
6784 return alpha_fold_builtin_zapnot (op, opint, op_const);
6785 }
6786
6787 static tree
6788 alpha_fold_builtin_umulh (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6789 {
6790 switch (op_const)
6791 {
6792 case 3:
6793 {
6794 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
6795 HOST_WIDE_INT h;
6796
6797 mul_double (opint[0], 0, opint[1], 0, &l, &h);
6798
6799 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > 64
6800 # error fixme
6801 #endif
6802
6803 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, h);
6804 }
6805
6806 case 1:
6807 opint[1] = opint[0];
6808 /* FALLTHRU */
6809 case 2:
6810 /* Note that (X*1) >> 64 == 0. */
6811 if (opint[1] == 0 || opint[1] == 1)
6812 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, 0);
6813 break;
6814 }
6815 return NULL;
6816 }
6817
6818 static tree
6819 alpha_fold_vector_minmax (enum tree_code code, tree op[], tree vtype)
6820 {
6821 tree op0 = fold_convert (vtype, op[0]);
6822 tree op1 = fold_convert (vtype, op[1]);
6823 tree val = fold_build2 (code, vtype, op0, op1);
6824 return fold_build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, long_integer_type_node, val);
6825 }
6826
6827 static tree
6828 alpha_fold_builtin_perr (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6829 {
6830 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp = 0;
6831 int i;
6832
6833 if (op_const != 3)
6834 return NULL;
6835
6836 for (i = 0; i < 8; ++i)
6837 {
6838 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT a = (opint[0] >> (i * 8)) & 0xff;
6839 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT b = (opint[1] >> (i * 8)) & 0xff;
6840 if (a >= b)
6841 temp += a - b;
6842 else
6843 temp += b - a;
6844 }
6845
6846 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, temp);
6847 }
6848
6849 static tree
6850 alpha_fold_builtin_pklb (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6851 {
6852 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp;
6853
6854 if (op_const == 0)
6855 return NULL;
6856
6857 temp = opint[0] & 0xff;
6858 temp |= (opint[0] >> 24) & 0xff00;
6859
6860 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, temp);
6861 }
6862
6863 static tree
6864 alpha_fold_builtin_pkwb (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6865 {
6866 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp;
6867
6868 if (op_const == 0)
6869 return NULL;
6870
6871 temp = opint[0] & 0xff;
6872 temp |= (opint[0] >> 8) & 0xff00;
6873 temp |= (opint[0] >> 16) & 0xff0000;
6874 temp |= (opint[0] >> 24) & 0xff000000;
6875
6876 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, temp);
6877 }
6878
6879 static tree
6880 alpha_fold_builtin_unpkbl (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6881 {
6882 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp;
6883
6884 if (op_const == 0)
6885 return NULL;
6886
6887 temp = opint[0] & 0xff;
6888 temp |= (opint[0] & 0xff00) << 24;
6889
6890 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, temp);
6891 }
6892
6893 static tree
6894 alpha_fold_builtin_unpkbw (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6895 {
6896 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp;
6897
6898 if (op_const == 0)
6899 return NULL;
6900
6901 temp = opint[0] & 0xff;
6902 temp |= (opint[0] & 0x0000ff00) << 8;
6903 temp |= (opint[0] & 0x00ff0000) << 16;
6904 temp |= (opint[0] & 0xff000000) << 24;
6905
6906 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, temp);
6907 }
6908
6909 static tree
6910 alpha_fold_builtin_cttz (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6911 {
6912 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp;
6913
6914 if (op_const == 0)
6915 return NULL;
6916
6917 if (opint[0] == 0)
6918 temp = 64;
6919 else
6920 temp = exact_log2 (opint[0] & -opint[0]);
6921
6922 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, temp);
6923 }
6924
6925 static tree
6926 alpha_fold_builtin_ctlz (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6927 {
6928 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp;
6929
6930 if (op_const == 0)
6931 return NULL;
6932
6933 if (opint[0] == 0)
6934 temp = 64;
6935 else
6936 temp = 64 - floor_log2 (opint[0]) - 1;
6937
6938 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, temp);
6939 }
6940
6941 static tree
6942 alpha_fold_builtin_ctpop (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[], long op_const)
6943 {
6944 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp, op;
6945
6946 if (op_const == 0)
6947 return NULL;
6948
6949 op = opint[0];
6950 temp = 0;
6951 while (op)
6952 temp++, op &= op - 1;
6953
6954 return build_int_cst (long_integer_type_node, temp);
6955 }
6956
6957 /* Fold one of our builtin functions. */
6958
6959 static tree
6960 alpha_fold_builtin (tree fndecl, int n_args, tree *op,
6961 bool ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
6962 {
6963 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT opint[MAX_ARGS];
6964 long op_const = 0;
6965 int i;
6966
6967 if (n_args >= MAX_ARGS)
6968 return NULL;
6969
6970 for (i = 0; i < n_args; i++)
6971 {
6972 tree arg = op[i];
6973 if (arg == error_mark_node)
6974 return NULL;
6975
6976 opint[i] = 0;
6977 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == INTEGER_CST)
6978 {
6979 op_const |= 1L << i;
6980 opint[i] = int_cst_value (arg);
6981 }
6982 }
6983
6984 switch (DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl))
6985 {
6986 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_CMPBGE:
6987 return alpha_fold_builtin_cmpbge (opint, op_const);
6988
6989 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTBL:
6990 return alpha_fold_builtin_extxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x01, false);
6991 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWL:
6992 return alpha_fold_builtin_extxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x03, false);
6993 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLL:
6994 return alpha_fold_builtin_extxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x0f, false);
6995 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQL:
6996 return alpha_fold_builtin_extxx (op, opint, op_const, 0xff, false);
6997 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTWH:
6998 return alpha_fold_builtin_extxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x03, true);
6999 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTLH:
7000 return alpha_fold_builtin_extxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x0f, true);
7001 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_EXTQH:
7002 return alpha_fold_builtin_extxx (op, opint, op_const, 0xff, true);
7003
7004 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSBL:
7005 return alpha_fold_builtin_insxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x01, false);
7006 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWL:
7007 return alpha_fold_builtin_insxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x03, false);
7008 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLL:
7009 return alpha_fold_builtin_insxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x0f, false);
7010 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQL:
7011 return alpha_fold_builtin_insxx (op, opint, op_const, 0xff, false);
7012 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSWH:
7013 return alpha_fold_builtin_insxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x03, true);
7014 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSLH:
7015 return alpha_fold_builtin_insxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x0f, true);
7016 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_INSQH:
7017 return alpha_fold_builtin_insxx (op, opint, op_const, 0xff, true);
7018
7019 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKBL:
7020 return alpha_fold_builtin_mskxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x01, false);
7021 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWL:
7022 return alpha_fold_builtin_mskxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x03, false);
7023 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLL:
7024 return alpha_fold_builtin_mskxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x0f, false);
7025 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQL:
7026 return alpha_fold_builtin_mskxx (op, opint, op_const, 0xff, false);
7027 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKWH:
7028 return alpha_fold_builtin_mskxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x03, true);
7029 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKLH:
7030 return alpha_fold_builtin_mskxx (op, opint, op_const, 0x0f, true);
7031 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MSKQH:
7032 return alpha_fold_builtin_mskxx (op, opint, op_const, 0xff, true);
7033
7034 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_UMULH:
7035 return alpha_fold_builtin_umulh (opint, op_const);
7036
7037 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAP:
7038 opint[1] ^= 0xff;
7039 /* FALLTHRU */
7040 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_ZAPNOT:
7041 return alpha_fold_builtin_zapnot (op, opint, op_const);
7042
7043 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUB8:
7044 return alpha_fold_vector_minmax (MIN_EXPR, op, alpha_v8qi_u);
7045 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSB8:
7046 return alpha_fold_vector_minmax (MIN_EXPR, op, alpha_v8qi_s);
7047 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINUW4:
7048 return alpha_fold_vector_minmax (MIN_EXPR, op, alpha_v4hi_u);
7049 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MINSW4:
7050 return alpha_fold_vector_minmax (MIN_EXPR, op, alpha_v4hi_s);
7051 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUB8:
7052 return alpha_fold_vector_minmax (MAX_EXPR, op, alpha_v8qi_u);
7053 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSB8:
7054 return alpha_fold_vector_minmax (MAX_EXPR, op, alpha_v8qi_s);
7055 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXUW4:
7056 return alpha_fold_vector_minmax (MAX_EXPR, op, alpha_v4hi_u);
7057 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_MAXSW4:
7058 return alpha_fold_vector_minmax (MAX_EXPR, op, alpha_v4hi_s);
7059
7060 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_PERR:
7061 return alpha_fold_builtin_perr (opint, op_const);
7062 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKLB:
7063 return alpha_fold_builtin_pklb (opint, op_const);
7064 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_PKWB:
7065 return alpha_fold_builtin_pkwb (opint, op_const);
7066 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBL:
7067 return alpha_fold_builtin_unpkbl (opint, op_const);
7068 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_UNPKBW:
7069 return alpha_fold_builtin_unpkbw (opint, op_const);
7070
7071 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTTZ:
7072 return alpha_fold_builtin_cttz (opint, op_const);
7073 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTLZ:
7074 return alpha_fold_builtin_ctlz (opint, op_const);
7075 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_CTPOP:
7076 return alpha_fold_builtin_ctpop (opint, op_const);
7077
7078 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_AMASK:
7079 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_IMPLVER:
7080 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_RPCC:
7081 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER:
7082 case ALPHA_BUILTIN_SET_THREAD_POINTER:
7083 /* None of these are foldable at compile-time. */
7084 default:
7085 return NULL;
7086 }
7087 }
7088 \f
7089 /* This page contains routines that are used to determine what the function
7090 prologue and epilogue code will do and write them out. */
7091
7092 /* Compute the size of the save area in the stack. */
7093
7094 /* These variables are used for communication between the following functions.
7095 They indicate various things about the current function being compiled
7096 that are used to tell what kind of prologue, epilogue and procedure
7097 descriptor to generate. */
7098
7099 /* Nonzero if we need a stack procedure. */
7100 enum alpha_procedure_types {PT_NULL = 0, PT_REGISTER = 1, PT_STACK = 2};
7101 static enum alpha_procedure_types alpha_procedure_type;
7102
7103 /* Register number (either FP or SP) that is used to unwind the frame. */
7104 static int vms_unwind_regno;
7105
7106 /* Register number used to save FP. We need not have one for RA since
7107 we don't modify it for register procedures. This is only defined
7108 for register frame procedures. */
7109 static int vms_save_fp_regno;
7110
7111 /* Register number used to reference objects off our PV. */
7112 static int vms_base_regno;
7113
7114 /* Compute register masks for saved registers. */
7115
7116 static void
7117 alpha_sa_mask (unsigned long *imaskP, unsigned long *fmaskP)
7118 {
7119 unsigned long imask = 0;
7120 unsigned long fmask = 0;
7121 unsigned int i;
7122
7123 /* When outputting a thunk, we don't have valid register life info,
7124 but assemble_start_function wants to output .frame and .mask
7125 directives. */
7126 if (cfun->is_thunk)
7127 {
7128 *imaskP = 0;
7129 *fmaskP = 0;
7130 return;
7131 }
7132
7133 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7134 imask |= (1UL << HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
7135
7136 /* One for every register we have to save. */
7137 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
7138 if (! fixed_regs[i] && ! call_used_regs[i]
7139 && df_regs_ever_live_p (i) && i != REG_RA)
7140 {
7141 if (i < 32)
7142 imask |= (1UL << i);
7143 else
7144 fmask |= (1UL << (i - 32));
7145 }
7146
7147 /* We need to restore these for the handler. */
7148 if (crtl->calls_eh_return)
7149 {
7150 for (i = 0; ; ++i)
7151 {
7152 unsigned regno = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
7153 if (regno == INVALID_REGNUM)
7154 break;
7155 imask |= 1UL << regno;
7156 }
7157 }
7158
7159 /* If any register spilled, then spill the return address also. */
7160 /* ??? This is required by the Digital stack unwind specification
7161 and isn't needed if we're doing Dwarf2 unwinding. */
7162 if (imask || fmask || alpha_ra_ever_killed ())
7163 imask |= (1UL << REG_RA);
7164
7165 *imaskP = imask;
7166 *fmaskP = fmask;
7167 }
7168
7169 int
7170 alpha_sa_size (void)
7171 {
7172 unsigned long mask[2];
7173 int sa_size = 0;
7174 int i, j;
7175
7176 alpha_sa_mask (&mask[0], &mask[1]);
7177
7178 for (j = 0; j < 2; ++j)
7179 for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i)
7180 if ((mask[j] >> i) & 1)
7181 sa_size++;
7182
7183 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7184 {
7185 /* Start with a stack procedure if we make any calls (REG_RA used), or
7186 need a frame pointer, with a register procedure if we otherwise need
7187 at least a slot, and with a null procedure in other cases. */
7188 if ((mask[0] >> REG_RA) & 1 || frame_pointer_needed)
7189 alpha_procedure_type = PT_STACK;
7190 else if (get_frame_size() != 0)
7191 alpha_procedure_type = PT_REGISTER;
7192 else
7193 alpha_procedure_type = PT_NULL;
7194
7195 /* Don't reserve space for saving FP & RA yet. Do that later after we've
7196 made the final decision on stack procedure vs register procedure. */
7197 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7198 sa_size -= 2;
7199
7200 /* Decide whether to refer to objects off our PV via FP or PV.
7201 If we need FP for something else or if we receive a nonlocal
7202 goto (which expects PV to contain the value), we must use PV.
7203 Otherwise, start by assuming we can use FP. */
7204
7205 vms_base_regno
7206 = (frame_pointer_needed
7207 || cfun->has_nonlocal_label
7208 || alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK
7209 || crtl->outgoing_args_size)
7210 ? REG_PV : HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
7211
7212 /* If we want to copy PV into FP, we need to find some register
7213 in which to save FP. */
7214
7215 vms_save_fp_regno = -1;
7216 if (vms_base_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
7217 for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
7218 if (! fixed_regs[i] && call_used_regs[i] && ! df_regs_ever_live_p (i))
7219 vms_save_fp_regno = i;
7220
7221 /* A VMS condition handler requires a stack procedure in our
7222 implementation. (not required by the calling standard). */
7223 if ((vms_save_fp_regno == -1 && alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER)
7224 || cfun->machine->uses_condition_handler)
7225 vms_base_regno = REG_PV, alpha_procedure_type = PT_STACK;
7226 else if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_NULL)
7227 vms_base_regno = REG_PV;
7228
7229 /* Stack unwinding should be done via FP unless we use it for PV. */
7230 vms_unwind_regno = (vms_base_regno == REG_PV
7231 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
7232
7233 /* If this is a stack procedure, allow space for saving FP, RA and
7234 a condition handler slot if needed. */
7235 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7236 sa_size += 2 + cfun->machine->uses_condition_handler;
7237 }
7238 else
7239 {
7240 /* Our size must be even (multiple of 16 bytes). */
7241 if (sa_size & 1)
7242 sa_size++;
7243 }
7244
7245 return sa_size * 8;
7246 }
7247
7248 /* Define the offset between two registers, one to be eliminated,
7249 and the other its replacement, at the start of a routine. */
7250
7251 HOST_WIDE_INT
7252 alpha_initial_elimination_offset (unsigned int from,
7253 unsigned int to ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7254 {
7255 HOST_WIDE_INT ret;
7256
7257 ret = alpha_sa_size ();
7258 ret += ALPHA_ROUND (crtl->outgoing_args_size);
7259
7260 switch (from)
7261 {
7262 case FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
7263 break;
7264
7265 case ARG_POINTER_REGNUM:
7266 ret += (ALPHA_ROUND (get_frame_size ()
7267 + crtl->args.pretend_args_size)
7268 - crtl->args.pretend_args_size);
7269 break;
7270
7271 default:
7272 gcc_unreachable ();
7273 }
7274
7275 return ret;
7276 }
7277
7278 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
7279
7280 /* Worker function for TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE. */
7281
7282 static bool
7283 alpha_vms_can_eliminate (const int from ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, const int to)
7284 {
7285 /* We need the alpha_procedure_type to decide. Evaluate it now. */
7286 alpha_sa_size ();
7287
7288 switch (alpha_procedure_type)
7289 {
7290 case PT_NULL:
7291 /* NULL procedures have no frame of their own and we only
7292 know how to resolve from the current stack pointer. */
7293 return to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
7294
7295 case PT_REGISTER:
7296 case PT_STACK:
7297 /* We always eliminate except to the stack pointer if there is no
7298 usable frame pointer at hand. */
7299 return (to != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
7300 || vms_unwind_regno != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
7301 }
7302
7303 gcc_unreachable ();
7304 }
7305
7306 /* FROM is to be eliminated for TO. Return the offset so that TO+offset
7307 designates the same location as FROM. */
7308
7309 HOST_WIDE_INT
7310 alpha_vms_initial_elimination_offset (unsigned int from, unsigned int to)
7311 {
7312 /* The only possible attempts we ever expect are ARG or FRAME_PTR to
7313 HARD_FRAME or STACK_PTR. We need the alpha_procedure_type to decide
7314 on the proper computations and will need the register save area size
7315 in most cases. */
7316
7317 HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size = alpha_sa_size ();
7318
7319 /* PT_NULL procedures have no frame of their own and we only allow
7320 elimination to the stack pointer. This is the argument pointer and we
7321 resolve the soft frame pointer to that as well. */
7322
7323 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_NULL)
7324 return 0;
7325
7326 /* For a PT_STACK procedure the frame layout looks as follows
7327
7328 -----> decreasing addresses
7329
7330 < size rounded up to 16 | likewise >
7331 --------------#------------------------------+++--------------+++-------#
7332 incoming args # pretended args | "frame" | regs sa | PV | outgoing args #
7333 --------------#---------------------------------------------------------#
7334 ^ ^ ^ ^
7335 ARG_PTR FRAME_PTR HARD_FRAME_PTR STACK_PTR
7336
7337
7338 PT_REGISTER procedures are similar in that they may have a frame of their
7339 own. They have no regs-sa/pv/outgoing-args area.
7340
7341 We first compute offset to HARD_FRAME_PTR, then add what we need to get
7342 to STACK_PTR if need be. */
7343
7344 {
7345 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
7346 HOST_WIDE_INT pv_save_size = alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0;
7347
7348 switch (from)
7349 {
7350 case FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
7351 offset = ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size + pv_save_size);
7352 break;
7353 case ARG_POINTER_REGNUM:
7354 offset = (ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size + pv_save_size
7355 + get_frame_size ()
7356 + crtl->args.pretend_args_size)
7357 - crtl->args.pretend_args_size);
7358 break;
7359 default:
7360 gcc_unreachable ();
7361 }
7362
7363 if (to == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
7364 offset += ALPHA_ROUND (crtl->outgoing_args_size);
7365
7366 return offset;
7367 }
7368 }
7369
7370 #define COMMON_OBJECT "common_object"
7371
7372 static tree
7373 common_object_handler (tree *node, tree name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7374 tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7375 bool *no_add_attrs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7376 {
7377 tree decl = *node;
7378 gcc_assert (DECL_P (decl));
7379
7380 DECL_COMMON (decl) = 1;
7381 return NULL_TREE;
7382 }
7383
7384 static const struct attribute_spec vms_attribute_table[] =
7385 {
7386 /* { name, min_len, max_len, decl_req, type_req, fn_type_req, handler,
7387 affects_type_identity } */
7388 { COMMON_OBJECT, 0, 1, true, false, false, common_object_handler, false },
7389 { NULL, 0, 0, false, false, false, NULL, false }
7390 };
7391
7392 void
7393 vms_output_aligned_decl_common(FILE *file, tree decl, const char *name,
7394 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size,
7395 unsigned int align)
7396 {
7397 tree attr = DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl);
7398 fprintf (file, "%s", COMMON_ASM_OP);
7399 assemble_name (file, name);
7400 fprintf (file, "," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, size);
7401 /* ??? Unlike on OSF/1, the alignment factor is not in log units. */
7402 fprintf (file, ",%u", align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7403 if (attr)
7404 {
7405 attr = lookup_attribute (COMMON_OBJECT, attr);
7406 if (attr)
7407 fprintf (file, ",%s",
7408 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
7409 }
7410 fputc ('\n', file);
7411 }
7412
7413 #undef COMMON_OBJECT
7414
7415 #endif
7416
7417 static int
7418 find_lo_sum_using_gp (rtx *px, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7419 {
7420 return GET_CODE (*px) == LO_SUM && XEXP (*px, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx;
7421 }
7422
7423 int
7424 alpha_find_lo_sum_using_gp (rtx insn)
7425 {
7426 return for_each_rtx (&PATTERN (insn), find_lo_sum_using_gp, NULL) > 0;
7427 }
7428
7429 static int
7430 alpha_does_function_need_gp (void)
7431 {
7432 rtx insn;
7433
7434 /* The GP being variable is an OSF abi thing. */
7435 if (! TARGET_ABI_OSF)
7436 return 0;
7437
7438 /* We need the gp to load the address of __mcount. */
7439 if (TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP && crtl->profile)
7440 return 1;
7441
7442 /* The code emitted by alpha_output_mi_thunk_osf uses the gp. */
7443 if (cfun->is_thunk)
7444 return 1;
7445
7446 /* The nonlocal receiver pattern assumes that the gp is valid for
7447 the nested function. Reasonable because it's almost always set
7448 correctly already. For the cases where that's wrong, make sure
7449 the nested function loads its gp on entry. */
7450 if (crtl->has_nonlocal_goto)
7451 return 1;
7452
7453 /* If we need a GP (we have a LDSYM insn or a CALL_INSN), load it first.
7454 Even if we are a static function, we still need to do this in case
7455 our address is taken and passed to something like qsort. */
7456
7457 push_topmost_sequence ();
7458 insn = get_insns ();
7459 pop_topmost_sequence ();
7460
7461 for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
7462 if (NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn)
7463 && ! JUMP_TABLE_DATA_P (insn)
7464 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE
7465 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER
7466 && get_attr_usegp (insn))
7467 return 1;
7468
7469 return 0;
7470 }
7471
7472 \f
7473 /* Helper function to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on instructions, including
7474 sequences. */
7475
7476 static rtx
7477 set_frame_related_p (void)
7478 {
7479 rtx seq = get_insns ();
7480 rtx insn;
7481
7482 end_sequence ();
7483
7484 if (!seq)
7485 return NULL_RTX;
7486
7487 if (INSN_P (seq))
7488 {
7489 insn = seq;
7490 while (insn != NULL_RTX)
7491 {
7492 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
7493 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
7494 }
7495 seq = emit_insn (seq);
7496 }
7497 else
7498 {
7499 seq = emit_insn (seq);
7500 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = 1;
7501 }
7502 return seq;
7503 }
7504
7505 #define FRP(exp) (start_sequence (), exp, set_frame_related_p ())
7506
7507 /* Generates a store with the proper unwind info attached. VALUE is
7508 stored at BASE_REG+BASE_OFS. If FRAME_BIAS is nonzero, then BASE_REG
7509 contains SP+FRAME_BIAS, and that is the unwind info that should be
7510 generated. If FRAME_REG != VALUE, then VALUE is being stored on
7511 behalf of FRAME_REG, and FRAME_REG should be present in the unwind. */
7512
7513 static void
7514 emit_frame_store_1 (rtx value, rtx base_reg, HOST_WIDE_INT frame_bias,
7515 HOST_WIDE_INT base_ofs, rtx frame_reg)
7516 {
7517 rtx addr, mem, insn;
7518
7519 addr = plus_constant (base_reg, base_ofs);
7520 mem = gen_frame_mem (DImode, addr);
7521
7522 insn = emit_move_insn (mem, value);
7523 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
7524
7525 if (frame_bias || value != frame_reg)
7526 {
7527 if (frame_bias)
7528 {
7529 addr = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, frame_bias + base_ofs);
7530 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, addr);
7531 }
7532
7533 add_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
7534 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, mem, frame_reg));
7535 }
7536 }
7537
7538 static void
7539 emit_frame_store (unsigned int regno, rtx base_reg,
7540 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_bias, HOST_WIDE_INT base_ofs)
7541 {
7542 rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, regno);
7543 emit_frame_store_1 (reg, base_reg, frame_bias, base_ofs, reg);
7544 }
7545
7546 /* Compute the frame size. SIZE is the size of the "naked" frame
7547 and SA_SIZE is the size of the register save area. */
7548
7549 static HOST_WIDE_INT
7550 compute_frame_size (HOST_WIDE_INT size, HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size)
7551 {
7552 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7553 return ALPHA_ROUND (sa_size
7554 + (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? 8 : 0)
7555 + size
7556 + crtl->args.pretend_args_size);
7557 else
7558 return ALPHA_ROUND (crtl->outgoing_args_size)
7559 + sa_size
7560 + ALPHA_ROUND (size
7561 + crtl->args.pretend_args_size);
7562 }
7563
7564 /* Write function prologue. */
7565
7566 /* On vms we have two kinds of functions:
7567
7568 - stack frame (PROC_STACK)
7569 these are 'normal' functions with local vars and which are
7570 calling other functions
7571 - register frame (PROC_REGISTER)
7572 keeps all data in registers, needs no stack
7573
7574 We must pass this to the assembler so it can generate the
7575 proper pdsc (procedure descriptor)
7576 This is done with the '.pdesc' command.
7577
7578 On not-vms, we don't really differentiate between the two, as we can
7579 simply allocate stack without saving registers. */
7580
7581 void
7582 alpha_expand_prologue (void)
7583 {
7584 /* Registers to save. */
7585 unsigned long imask = 0;
7586 unsigned long fmask = 0;
7587 /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */
7588 HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size, sa_bias;
7589 /* Complete stack size needed. */
7590 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size;
7591 /* Probed stack size; it additionally includes the size of
7592 the "reserve region" if any. */
7593 HOST_WIDE_INT probed_size;
7594 /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */
7595 HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset;
7596 rtx sa_reg;
7597 int i;
7598
7599 sa_size = alpha_sa_size ();
7600 frame_size = compute_frame_size (get_frame_size (), sa_size);
7601
7602 if (flag_stack_usage_info)
7603 current_function_static_stack_size = frame_size;
7604
7605 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7606 reg_offset = 8 + 8 * cfun->machine->uses_condition_handler;
7607 else
7608 reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (crtl->outgoing_args_size);
7609
7610 alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask);
7611
7612 /* Emit an insn to reload GP, if needed. */
7613 if (TARGET_ABI_OSF)
7614 {
7615 alpha_function_needs_gp = alpha_does_function_need_gp ();
7616 if (alpha_function_needs_gp)
7617 emit_insn (gen_prologue_ldgp ());
7618 }
7619
7620 /* TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP actually implies that we need to insert
7621 the call to mcount ourselves, rather than having the linker do it
7622 magically in response to -pg. Since _mcount has special linkage,
7623 don't represent the call as a call. */
7624 if (TARGET_PROFILING_NEEDS_GP && crtl->profile)
7625 emit_insn (gen_prologue_mcount ());
7626
7627 /* Adjust the stack by the frame size. If the frame size is > 4096
7628 bytes, we need to be sure we probe somewhere in the first and last
7629 4096 bytes (we can probably get away without the latter test) and
7630 every 8192 bytes in between. If the frame size is > 32768, we
7631 do this in a loop. Otherwise, we generate the explicit probe
7632 instructions.
7633
7634 Note that we are only allowed to adjust sp once in the prologue. */
7635
7636 probed_size = frame_size;
7637 if (flag_stack_check)
7638 probed_size += STACK_CHECK_PROTECT;
7639
7640 if (probed_size <= 32768)
7641 {
7642 if (probed_size > 4096)
7643 {
7644 int probed;
7645
7646 for (probed = 4096; probed < probed_size; probed += 8192)
7647 emit_insn (gen_probe_stack (GEN_INT (-probed)));
7648
7649 /* We only have to do this probe if we aren't saving registers or
7650 if we are probing beyond the frame because of -fstack-check. */
7651 if ((sa_size == 0 && probed_size > probed - 4096)
7652 || flag_stack_check)
7653 emit_insn (gen_probe_stack (GEN_INT (-probed_size)));
7654 }
7655
7656 if (frame_size != 0)
7657 FRP (emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
7658 GEN_INT (-frame_size))));
7659 }
7660 else
7661 {
7662 /* Here we generate code to set R22 to SP + 4096 and set R23 to the
7663 number of 8192 byte blocks to probe. We then probe each block
7664 in the loop and then set SP to the proper location. If the
7665 amount remaining is > 4096, we have to do one more probe if we
7666 are not saving any registers or if we are probing beyond the
7667 frame because of -fstack-check. */
7668
7669 HOST_WIDE_INT blocks = (probed_size + 4096) / 8192;
7670 HOST_WIDE_INT leftover = probed_size + 4096 - blocks * 8192;
7671 rtx ptr = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 22);
7672 rtx count = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
7673 rtx seq;
7674
7675 emit_move_insn (count, GEN_INT (blocks));
7676 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (ptr, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (4096)));
7677
7678 /* Because of the difficulty in emitting a new basic block this
7679 late in the compilation, generate the loop as a single insn. */
7680 emit_insn (gen_prologue_stack_probe_loop (count, ptr));
7681
7682 if ((leftover > 4096 && sa_size == 0) || flag_stack_check)
7683 {
7684 rtx last = gen_rtx_MEM (DImode, plus_constant (ptr, -leftover));
7685 MEM_VOLATILE_P (last) = 1;
7686 emit_move_insn (last, const0_rtx);
7687 }
7688
7689 if (flag_stack_check)
7690 {
7691 /* If -fstack-check is specified we have to load the entire
7692 constant into a register and subtract from the sp in one go,
7693 because the probed stack size is not equal to the frame size. */
7694 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
7695 lo = ((frame_size & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
7696 hi = frame_size - lo;
7697
7698 emit_move_insn (ptr, GEN_INT (hi));
7699 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (ptr, ptr, GEN_INT (lo)));
7700 seq = emit_insn (gen_subdi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
7701 ptr));
7702 }
7703 else
7704 {
7705 seq = emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, ptr,
7706 GEN_INT (-leftover)));
7707 }
7708
7709 /* This alternative is special, because the DWARF code cannot
7710 possibly intuit through the loop above. So we invent this
7711 note it looks at instead. */
7712 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = 1;
7713 add_reg_note (seq, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
7714 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
7715 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
7716 -frame_size)));
7717 }
7718
7719 /* Cope with very large offsets to the register save area. */
7720 sa_bias = 0;
7721 sa_reg = stack_pointer_rtx;
7722 if (reg_offset + sa_size > 0x8000)
7723 {
7724 int low = ((reg_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
7725 rtx sa_bias_rtx;
7726
7727 if (low + sa_size <= 0x8000)
7728 sa_bias = reg_offset - low, reg_offset = low;
7729 else
7730 sa_bias = reg_offset, reg_offset = 0;
7731
7732 sa_reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 24);
7733 sa_bias_rtx = GEN_INT (sa_bias);
7734
7735 if (add_operand (sa_bias_rtx, DImode))
7736 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (sa_reg, stack_pointer_rtx, sa_bias_rtx));
7737 else
7738 {
7739 emit_move_insn (sa_reg, sa_bias_rtx);
7740 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (sa_reg, stack_pointer_rtx, sa_reg));
7741 }
7742 }
7743
7744 /* Save regs in stack order. Beginning with VMS PV. */
7745 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
7746 emit_frame_store (REG_PV, stack_pointer_rtx, 0, 0);
7747
7748 /* Save register RA next. */
7749 if (imask & (1UL << REG_RA))
7750 {
7751 emit_frame_store (REG_RA, sa_reg, sa_bias, reg_offset);
7752 imask &= ~(1UL << REG_RA);
7753 reg_offset += 8;
7754 }
7755
7756 /* Now save any other registers required to be saved. */
7757 for (i = 0; i < 31; i++)
7758 if (imask & (1UL << i))
7759 {
7760 emit_frame_store (i, sa_reg, sa_bias, reg_offset);
7761 reg_offset += 8;
7762 }
7763
7764 for (i = 0; i < 31; i++)
7765 if (fmask & (1UL << i))
7766 {
7767 emit_frame_store (i+32, sa_reg, sa_bias, reg_offset);
7768 reg_offset += 8;
7769 }
7770
7771 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7772 {
7773 /* Register frame procedures save the fp. */
7774 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER)
7775 {
7776 rtx insn = emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno),
7777 hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
7778 add_reg_note (insn, REG_CFA_REGISTER, NULL);
7779 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
7780 }
7781
7782 if (alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL && vms_base_regno != REG_PV)
7783 emit_insn (gen_force_movdi (gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_base_regno),
7784 gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_PV)));
7785
7786 if (alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL
7787 && vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
7788 FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx));
7789
7790 /* If we have to allocate space for outgoing args, do it now. */
7791 if (crtl->outgoing_args_size != 0)
7792 {
7793 rtx seq
7794 = emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
7795 plus_constant
7796 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7797 - (ALPHA_ROUND
7798 (crtl->outgoing_args_size))));
7799
7800 /* Only set FRAME_RELATED_P on the stack adjustment we just emitted
7801 if ! frame_pointer_needed. Setting the bit will change the CFA
7802 computation rule to use sp again, which would be wrong if we had
7803 frame_pointer_needed, as this means sp might move unpredictably
7804 later on.
7805
7806 Also, note that
7807 frame_pointer_needed
7808 => vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
7809 and
7810 crtl->outgoing_args_size != 0
7811 => alpha_procedure_type != PT_NULL,
7812
7813 so when we are not setting the bit here, we are guaranteed to
7814 have emitted an FRP frame pointer update just before. */
7815 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (seq) = ! frame_pointer_needed;
7816 }
7817 }
7818 else
7819 {
7820 /* If we need a frame pointer, set it from the stack pointer. */
7821 if (frame_pointer_needed)
7822 {
7823 if (TARGET_CAN_FAULT_IN_PROLOGUE)
7824 FRP (emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx));
7825 else
7826 /* This must always be the last instruction in the
7827 prologue, thus we emit a special move + clobber. */
7828 FRP (emit_insn (gen_init_fp (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
7829 stack_pointer_rtx, sa_reg)));
7830 }
7831 }
7832
7833 /* The ABIs for VMS and OSF/1 say that while we can schedule insns into
7834 the prologue, for exception handling reasons, we cannot do this for
7835 any insn that might fault. We could prevent this for mems with a
7836 (clobber:BLK (scratch)), but this doesn't work for fp insns. So we
7837 have to prevent all such scheduling with a blockage.
7838
7839 Linux, on the other hand, never bothered to implement OSF/1's
7840 exception handling, and so doesn't care about such things. Anyone
7841 planning to use dwarf2 frame-unwind info can also omit the blockage. */
7842
7843 if (! TARGET_CAN_FAULT_IN_PROLOGUE)
7844 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
7845 }
7846
7847 /* Count the number of .file directives, so that .loc is up to date. */
7848 int num_source_filenames = 0;
7849
7850 /* Output the textual info surrounding the prologue. */
7851
7852 void
7853 alpha_start_function (FILE *file, const char *fnname,
7854 tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7855 {
7856 unsigned long imask = 0;
7857 unsigned long fmask = 0;
7858 /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */
7859 HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size;
7860 /* Complete stack size needed. */
7861 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size;
7862 /* The maximum debuggable frame size (512 Kbytes using Tru64 as). */
7863 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_frame_size = TARGET_ABI_OSF && !TARGET_GAS
7864 ? 524288
7865 : 1UL << 31;
7866 /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */
7867 HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset;
7868 char *entry_label = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 6);
7869 char *tramp_label = (char *) alloca (strlen (fnname) + 6);
7870 int i;
7871
7872 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
7873 if (vms_debug_main
7874 && strncmp (vms_debug_main, fnname, strlen (vms_debug_main)) == 0)
7875 {
7876 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
7877 ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (asm_out_file, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER, fnname);
7878 switch_to_section (text_section);
7879 vms_debug_main = NULL;
7880 }
7881 #endif
7882
7883 alpha_fnname = fnname;
7884 sa_size = alpha_sa_size ();
7885 frame_size = compute_frame_size (get_frame_size (), sa_size);
7886
7887 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7888 reg_offset = 8 + 8 * cfun->machine->uses_condition_handler;
7889 else
7890 reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (crtl->outgoing_args_size);
7891
7892 alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask);
7893
7894 /* Ecoff can handle multiple .file directives, so put out file and lineno.
7895 We have to do that before the .ent directive as we cannot switch
7896 files within procedures with native ecoff because line numbers are
7897 linked to procedure descriptors.
7898 Outputting the lineno helps debugging of one line functions as they
7899 would otherwise get no line number at all. Please note that we would
7900 like to put out last_linenum from final.c, but it is not accessible. */
7901
7902 if (write_symbols == SDB_DEBUG)
7903 {
7904 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7905 ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (file,
7906 DECL_SOURCE_FILE (current_function_decl));
7907 #endif
7908 #ifdef SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
7909 if (debug_info_level != DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
7910 SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (file,
7911 DECL_SOURCE_LINE (current_function_decl));
7912 #endif
7913 }
7914
7915 /* Issue function start and label. */
7916 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS || !flag_inhibit_size_directive)
7917 {
7918 fputs ("\t.ent ", file);
7919 assemble_name (file, fnname);
7920 putc ('\n', file);
7921
7922 /* If the function needs GP, we'll write the "..ng" label there.
7923 Otherwise, do it here. */
7924 if (TARGET_ABI_OSF
7925 && ! alpha_function_needs_gp
7926 && ! cfun->is_thunk)
7927 {
7928 putc ('$', file);
7929 assemble_name (file, fnname);
7930 fputs ("..ng:\n", file);
7931 }
7932 }
7933 /* Nested functions on VMS that are potentially called via trampoline
7934 get a special transfer entry point that loads the called functions
7935 procedure descriptor and static chain. */
7936 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
7937 && !TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
7938 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
7939 && !TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
7940 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) != TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL)
7941 {
7942 strcpy (tramp_label, fnname);
7943 strcat (tramp_label, "..tr");
7944 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (file, tramp_label);
7945 fprintf (file, "\tldq $1,24($27)\n");
7946 fprintf (file, "\tldq $27,16($27)\n");
7947 }
7948
7949 strcpy (entry_label, fnname);
7950 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7951 strcat (entry_label, "..en");
7952
7953 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (file, entry_label);
7954 inside_function = TRUE;
7955
7956 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7957 fprintf (file, "\t.base $%d\n", vms_base_regno);
7958
7959 if (TARGET_ABI_OSF
7960 && TARGET_IEEE_CONFORMANT
7961 && !flag_inhibit_size_directive)
7962 {
7963 /* Set flags in procedure descriptor to request IEEE-conformant
7964 math-library routines. The value we set it to is PDSC_EXC_IEEE
7965 (/usr/include/pdsc.h). */
7966 fputs ("\t.eflag 48\n", file);
7967 }
7968
7969 /* Set up offsets to alpha virtual arg/local debugging pointer. */
7970 alpha_auto_offset = -frame_size + crtl->args.pretend_args_size;
7971 alpha_arg_offset = -frame_size + 48;
7972
7973 /* Describe our frame. If the frame size is larger than an integer,
7974 print it as zero to avoid an assembler error. We won't be
7975 properly describing such a frame, but that's the best we can do. */
7976 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7977 fprintf (file, "\t.frame $%d," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ",$26,"
7978 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
7979 vms_unwind_regno,
7980 frame_size >= (1UL << 31) ? 0 : frame_size,
7981 reg_offset);
7982 else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
7983 fprintf (file, "\t.frame $%d," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC ",$26,%d\n",
7984 (frame_pointer_needed
7985 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM),
7986 frame_size >= max_frame_size ? 0 : frame_size,
7987 crtl->args.pretend_args_size);
7988
7989 /* Describe which registers were spilled. */
7990 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
7991 {
7992 if (imask)
7993 /* ??? Does VMS care if mask contains ra? The old code didn't
7994 set it, so I don't here. */
7995 fprintf (file, "\t.mask 0x%lx,0\n", imask & ~(1UL << REG_RA));
7996 if (fmask)
7997 fprintf (file, "\t.fmask 0x%lx,0\n", fmask);
7998 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER)
7999 fprintf (file, "\t.fp_save $%d\n", vms_save_fp_regno);
8000 }
8001 else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
8002 {
8003 if (imask)
8004 {
8005 fprintf (file, "\t.mask 0x%lx," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n", imask,
8006 frame_size >= max_frame_size ? 0 : reg_offset - frame_size);
8007
8008 for (i = 0; i < 32; ++i)
8009 if (imask & (1UL << i))
8010 reg_offset += 8;
8011 }
8012
8013 if (fmask)
8014 fprintf (file, "\t.fmask 0x%lx," HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n", fmask,
8015 frame_size >= max_frame_size ? 0 : reg_offset - frame_size);
8016 }
8017
8018 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
8019 /* If a user condition handler has been installed at some point, emit
8020 the procedure descriptor bits to point the Condition Handling Facility
8021 at the indirection wrapper, and state the fp offset at which the user
8022 handler may be found. */
8023 if (cfun->machine->uses_condition_handler)
8024 {
8025 fprintf (file, "\t.handler __gcc_shell_handler\n");
8026 fprintf (file, "\t.handler_data %d\n", VMS_COND_HANDLER_FP_OFFSET);
8027 }
8028
8029 #ifdef TARGET_VMS_CRASH_DEBUG
8030 /* Support of minimal traceback info. */
8031 switch_to_section (readonly_data_section);
8032 fprintf (file, "\t.align 3\n");
8033 assemble_name (file, fnname); fputs ("..na:\n", file);
8034 fputs ("\t.ascii \"", file);
8035 assemble_name (file, fnname);
8036 fputs ("\\0\"\n", file);
8037 switch_to_section (text_section);
8038 #endif
8039 #endif /* TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS */
8040 }
8041
8042 /* Emit the .prologue note at the scheduled end of the prologue. */
8043
8044 static void
8045 alpha_output_function_end_prologue (FILE *file)
8046 {
8047 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
8048 fputs ("\t.prologue\n", file);
8049 else if (!flag_inhibit_size_directive)
8050 fprintf (file, "\t.prologue %d\n",
8051 alpha_function_needs_gp || cfun->is_thunk);
8052 }
8053
8054 /* Write function epilogue. */
8055
8056 void
8057 alpha_expand_epilogue (void)
8058 {
8059 /* Registers to save. */
8060 unsigned long imask = 0;
8061 unsigned long fmask = 0;
8062 /* Stack space needed for pushing registers clobbered by us. */
8063 HOST_WIDE_INT sa_size;
8064 /* Complete stack size needed. */
8065 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size;
8066 /* Offset from base reg to register save area. */
8067 HOST_WIDE_INT reg_offset;
8068 int fp_is_frame_pointer, fp_offset;
8069 rtx sa_reg, sa_reg_exp = NULL;
8070 rtx sp_adj1, sp_adj2, mem, reg, insn;
8071 rtx eh_ofs;
8072 rtx cfa_restores = NULL_RTX;
8073 int i;
8074
8075 sa_size = alpha_sa_size ();
8076 frame_size = compute_frame_size (get_frame_size (), sa_size);
8077
8078 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
8079 {
8080 if (alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK)
8081 reg_offset = 8 + 8 * cfun->machine->uses_condition_handler;
8082 else
8083 reg_offset = 0;
8084 }
8085 else
8086 reg_offset = ALPHA_ROUND (crtl->outgoing_args_size);
8087
8088 alpha_sa_mask (&imask, &fmask);
8089
8090 fp_is_frame_pointer
8091 = (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
8092 ? alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK
8093 : frame_pointer_needed);
8094 fp_offset = 0;
8095 sa_reg = stack_pointer_rtx;
8096
8097 if (crtl->calls_eh_return)
8098 eh_ofs = EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX;
8099 else
8100 eh_ofs = NULL_RTX;
8101
8102 if (sa_size)
8103 {
8104 /* If we have a frame pointer, restore SP from it. */
8105 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
8106 ? vms_unwind_regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
8107 : frame_pointer_needed)
8108 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
8109
8110 /* Cope with very large offsets to the register save area. */
8111 if (reg_offset + sa_size > 0x8000)
8112 {
8113 int low = ((reg_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
8114 HOST_WIDE_INT bias;
8115
8116 if (low + sa_size <= 0x8000)
8117 bias = reg_offset - low, reg_offset = low;
8118 else
8119 bias = reg_offset, reg_offset = 0;
8120
8121 sa_reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 22);
8122 sa_reg_exp = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, bias);
8123
8124 emit_move_insn (sa_reg, sa_reg_exp);
8125 }
8126
8127 /* Restore registers in order, excepting a true frame pointer. */
8128
8129 mem = gen_frame_mem (DImode, plus_constant (sa_reg, reg_offset));
8130 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, REG_RA);
8131 emit_move_insn (reg, mem);
8132 cfa_restores = alloc_reg_note (REG_CFA_RESTORE, reg, cfa_restores);
8133
8134 reg_offset += 8;
8135 imask &= ~(1UL << REG_RA);
8136
8137 for (i = 0; i < 31; ++i)
8138 if (imask & (1UL << i))
8139 {
8140 if (i == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && fp_is_frame_pointer)
8141 fp_offset = reg_offset;
8142 else
8143 {
8144 mem = gen_frame_mem (DImode,
8145 plus_constant (sa_reg, reg_offset));
8146 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, i);
8147 emit_move_insn (reg, mem);
8148 cfa_restores = alloc_reg_note (REG_CFA_RESTORE, reg,
8149 cfa_restores);
8150 }
8151 reg_offset += 8;
8152 }
8153
8154 for (i = 0; i < 31; ++i)
8155 if (fmask & (1UL << i))
8156 {
8157 mem = gen_frame_mem (DFmode, plus_constant (sa_reg, reg_offset));
8158 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, i+32);
8159 emit_move_insn (reg, mem);
8160 cfa_restores = alloc_reg_note (REG_CFA_RESTORE, reg, cfa_restores);
8161 reg_offset += 8;
8162 }
8163 }
8164
8165 if (frame_size || eh_ofs)
8166 {
8167 sp_adj1 = stack_pointer_rtx;
8168
8169 if (eh_ofs)
8170 {
8171 sp_adj1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
8172 emit_move_insn (sp_adj1,
8173 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, eh_ofs));
8174 }
8175
8176 /* If the stack size is large, begin computation into a temporary
8177 register so as not to interfere with a potential fp restore,
8178 which must be consecutive with an SP restore. */
8179 if (frame_size < 32768 && !cfun->calls_alloca)
8180 sp_adj2 = GEN_INT (frame_size);
8181 else if (frame_size < 0x40007fffL)
8182 {
8183 int low = ((frame_size & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
8184
8185 sp_adj2 = plus_constant (sp_adj1, frame_size - low);
8186 if (sa_reg_exp && rtx_equal_p (sa_reg_exp, sp_adj2))
8187 sp_adj1 = sa_reg;
8188 else
8189 {
8190 sp_adj1 = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
8191 emit_move_insn (sp_adj1, sp_adj2);
8192 }
8193 sp_adj2 = GEN_INT (low);
8194 }
8195 else
8196 {
8197 rtx tmp = gen_rtx_REG (DImode, 23);
8198 sp_adj2 = alpha_emit_set_const (tmp, DImode, frame_size, 3, false);
8199 if (!sp_adj2)
8200 {
8201 /* We can't drop new things to memory this late, afaik,
8202 so build it up by pieces. */
8203 sp_adj2 = alpha_emit_set_long_const (tmp, frame_size,
8204 -(frame_size < 0));
8205 gcc_assert (sp_adj2);
8206 }
8207 }
8208
8209 /* From now on, things must be in order. So emit blockages. */
8210
8211 /* Restore the frame pointer. */
8212 if (fp_is_frame_pointer)
8213 {
8214 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
8215 mem = gen_frame_mem (DImode, plus_constant (sa_reg, fp_offset));
8216 emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, mem);
8217 cfa_restores = alloc_reg_note (REG_CFA_RESTORE,
8218 hard_frame_pointer_rtx, cfa_restores);
8219 }
8220 else if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
8221 {
8222 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
8223 emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
8224 gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno));
8225 cfa_restores = alloc_reg_note (REG_CFA_RESTORE,
8226 hard_frame_pointer_rtx, cfa_restores);
8227 }
8228
8229 /* Restore the stack pointer. */
8230 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
8231 if (sp_adj2 == const0_rtx)
8232 insn = emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, sp_adj1);
8233 else
8234 insn = emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
8235 gen_rtx_PLUS (DImode, sp_adj1, sp_adj2));
8236 REG_NOTES (insn) = cfa_restores;
8237 add_reg_note (insn, REG_CFA_DEF_CFA, stack_pointer_rtx);
8238 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
8239 }
8240 else
8241 {
8242 gcc_assert (cfa_restores == NULL);
8243
8244 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS && alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER)
8245 {
8246 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
8247 insn = emit_move_insn (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
8248 gen_rtx_REG (DImode, vms_save_fp_regno));
8249 add_reg_note (insn, REG_CFA_RESTORE, hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
8250 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
8251 }
8252 }
8253 }
8254 \f
8255 /* Output the rest of the textual info surrounding the epilogue. */
8256
8257 void
8258 alpha_end_function (FILE *file, const char *fnname, tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
8259 {
8260 rtx insn;
8261
8262 /* We output a nop after noreturn calls at the very end of the function to
8263 ensure that the return address always remains in the caller's code range,
8264 as not doing so might confuse unwinding engines. */
8265 insn = get_last_insn ();
8266 if (!INSN_P (insn))
8267 insn = prev_active_insn (insn);
8268 if (insn && CALL_P (insn))
8269 output_asm_insn (get_insn_template (CODE_FOR_nop, NULL), NULL);
8270
8271 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
8272 /* Write the linkage entries. */
8273 alpha_write_linkage (file, fnname);
8274 #endif
8275
8276 /* End the function. */
8277 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
8278 || !flag_inhibit_size_directive)
8279 {
8280 fputs ("\t.end ", file);
8281 assemble_name (file, fnname);
8282 putc ('\n', file);
8283 }
8284 inside_function = FALSE;
8285 }
8286
8287 #if TARGET_ABI_OSF
8288 /* Emit a tail call to FUNCTION after adjusting THIS by DELTA.
8289
8290 In order to avoid the hordes of differences between generated code
8291 with and without TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS, and to avoid duplicating
8292 lots of code loading up large constants, generate rtl and emit it
8293 instead of going straight to text.
8294
8295 Not sure why this idea hasn't been explored before... */
8296
8297 static void
8298 alpha_output_mi_thunk_osf (FILE *file, tree thunk_fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8299 HOST_WIDE_INT delta, HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset,
8300 tree function)
8301 {
8302 HOST_WIDE_INT hi, lo;
8303 rtx this_rtx, insn, funexp;
8304
8305 /* We always require a valid GP. */
8306 emit_insn (gen_prologue_ldgp ());
8307 emit_note (NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END);
8308
8309 /* Find the "this" pointer. If the function returns a structure,
8310 the structure return pointer is in $16. */
8311 if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (function)), function))
8312 this_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 17);
8313 else
8314 this_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 16);
8315
8316 /* Add DELTA. When possible we use ldah+lda. Otherwise load the
8317 entire constant for the add. */
8318 lo = ((delta & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
8319 hi = (((delta - lo) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
8320 if (hi + lo == delta)
8321 {
8322 if (hi)
8323 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this_rtx, this_rtx, GEN_INT (hi)));
8324 if (lo)
8325 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this_rtx, this_rtx, GEN_INT (lo)));
8326 }
8327 else
8328 {
8329 rtx tmp = alpha_emit_set_long_const (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0),
8330 delta, -(delta < 0));
8331 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this_rtx, this_rtx, tmp));
8332 }
8333
8334 /* Add a delta stored in the vtable at VCALL_OFFSET. */
8335 if (vcall_offset)
8336 {
8337 rtx tmp, tmp2;
8338
8339 tmp = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 0);
8340 emit_move_insn (tmp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, this_rtx));
8341
8342 lo = ((vcall_offset & 0xffff) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
8343 hi = (((vcall_offset - lo) & 0xffffffff) ^ 0x80000000) - 0x80000000;
8344 if (hi + lo == vcall_offset)
8345 {
8346 if (hi)
8347 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (tmp, tmp, GEN_INT (hi)));
8348 }
8349 else
8350 {
8351 tmp2 = alpha_emit_set_long_const (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, 1),
8352 vcall_offset, -(vcall_offset < 0));
8353 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (tmp, tmp, tmp2));
8354 lo = 0;
8355 }
8356 if (lo)
8357 tmp2 = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tmp, GEN_INT (lo));
8358 else
8359 tmp2 = tmp;
8360 emit_move_insn (tmp, gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, tmp2));
8361
8362 emit_insn (gen_adddi3 (this_rtx, this_rtx, tmp));
8363 }
8364
8365 /* Generate a tail call to the target function. */
8366 if (! TREE_USED (function))
8367 {
8368 assemble_external (function);
8369 TREE_USED (function) = 1;
8370 }
8371 funexp = XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0);
8372 funexp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, funexp);
8373 insn = emit_call_insn (gen_sibcall (funexp, const0_rtx));
8374 SIBLING_CALL_P (insn) = 1;
8375
8376 /* Run just enough of rest_of_compilation to get the insns emitted.
8377 There's not really enough bulk here to make other passes such as
8378 instruction scheduling worth while. Note that use_thunk calls
8379 assemble_start_function and assemble_end_function. */
8380 insn = get_insns ();
8381 insn_locators_alloc ();
8382 shorten_branches (insn);
8383 final_start_function (insn, file, 1);
8384 final (insn, file, 1);
8385 final_end_function ();
8386 }
8387 #endif /* TARGET_ABI_OSF */
8388 \f
8389 /* Debugging support. */
8390
8391 #include "gstab.h"
8392
8393 /* Count the number of sdb related labels are generated (to find block
8394 start and end boundaries). */
8395
8396 int sdb_label_count = 0;
8397
8398 /* Name of the file containing the current function. */
8399
8400 static const char *current_function_file = "";
8401
8402 /* Offsets to alpha virtual arg/local debugging pointers. */
8403
8404 long alpha_arg_offset;
8405 long alpha_auto_offset;
8406 \f
8407 /* Emit a new filename to a stream. */
8408
8409 void
8410 alpha_output_filename (FILE *stream, const char *name)
8411 {
8412 static int first_time = TRUE;
8413
8414 if (first_time)
8415 {
8416 first_time = FALSE;
8417 ++num_source_filenames;
8418 current_function_file = name;
8419 fprintf (stream, "\t.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames);
8420 output_quoted_string (stream, name);
8421 fprintf (stream, "\n");
8422 if (!TARGET_GAS && write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
8423 fprintf (stream, "\t#@stabs\n");
8424 }
8425
8426 else if (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG)
8427 /* dbxout.c will emit an appropriate .stabs directive. */
8428 return;
8429
8430 else if (name != current_function_file
8431 && strcmp (name, current_function_file) != 0)
8432 {
8433 if (inside_function && ! TARGET_GAS)
8434 fprintf (stream, "\t#.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames);
8435 else
8436 {
8437 ++num_source_filenames;
8438 current_function_file = name;
8439 fprintf (stream, "\t.file\t%d ", num_source_filenames);
8440 }
8441
8442 output_quoted_string (stream, name);
8443 fprintf (stream, "\n");
8444 }
8445 }
8446 \f
8447 /* Structure to show the current status of registers and memory. */
8448
8449 struct shadow_summary
8450 {
8451 struct {
8452 unsigned int i : 31; /* Mask of int regs */
8453 unsigned int fp : 31; /* Mask of fp regs */
8454 unsigned int mem : 1; /* mem == imem | fpmem */
8455 } used, defd;
8456 };
8457
8458 /* Summary the effects of expression X on the machine. Update SUM, a pointer
8459 to the summary structure. SET is nonzero if the insn is setting the
8460 object, otherwise zero. */
8461
8462 static void
8463 summarize_insn (rtx x, struct shadow_summary *sum, int set)
8464 {
8465 const char *format_ptr;
8466 int i, j;
8467
8468 if (x == 0)
8469 return;
8470
8471 switch (GET_CODE (x))
8472 {
8473 /* ??? Note that this case would be incorrect if the Alpha had a
8474 ZERO_EXTRACT in SET_DEST. */
8475 case SET:
8476 summarize_insn (SET_SRC (x), sum, 0);
8477 summarize_insn (SET_DEST (x), sum, 1);
8478 break;
8479
8480 case CLOBBER:
8481 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 1);
8482 break;
8483
8484 case USE:
8485 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0);
8486 break;
8487
8488 case ASM_OPERANDS:
8489 for (i = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_LENGTH (x) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8490 summarize_insn (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT (x, i), sum, 0);
8491 break;
8492
8493 case PARALLEL:
8494 for (i = XVECLEN (x, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8495 summarize_insn (XVECEXP (x, 0, i), sum, 0);
8496 break;
8497
8498 case SUBREG:
8499 summarize_insn (SUBREG_REG (x), sum, 0);
8500 break;
8501
8502 case REG:
8503 {
8504 int regno = REGNO (x);
8505 unsigned long mask = ((unsigned long) 1) << (regno % 32);
8506
8507 if (regno == 31 || regno == 63)
8508 break;
8509
8510 if (set)
8511 {
8512 if (regno < 32)
8513 sum->defd.i |= mask;
8514 else
8515 sum->defd.fp |= mask;
8516 }
8517 else
8518 {
8519 if (regno < 32)
8520 sum->used.i |= mask;
8521 else
8522 sum->used.fp |= mask;
8523 }
8524 }
8525 break;
8526
8527 case MEM:
8528 if (set)
8529 sum->defd.mem = 1;
8530 else
8531 sum->used.mem = 1;
8532
8533 /* Find the regs used in memory address computation: */
8534 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0);
8535 break;
8536
8537 case CONST_INT: case CONST_DOUBLE:
8538 case SYMBOL_REF: case LABEL_REF: case CONST:
8539 case SCRATCH: case ASM_INPUT:
8540 break;
8541
8542 /* Handle common unary and binary ops for efficiency. */
8543 case COMPARE: case PLUS: case MINUS: case MULT: case DIV:
8544 case MOD: case UDIV: case UMOD: case AND: case IOR:
8545 case XOR: case ASHIFT: case ROTATE: case ASHIFTRT: case LSHIFTRT:
8546 case ROTATERT: case SMIN: case SMAX: case UMIN: case UMAX:
8547 case NE: case EQ: case GE: case GT: case LE:
8548 case LT: case GEU: case GTU: case LEU: case LTU:
8549 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0);
8550 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 1), sum, 0);
8551 break;
8552
8553 case NEG: case NOT: case SIGN_EXTEND: case ZERO_EXTEND:
8554 case TRUNCATE: case FLOAT_EXTEND: case FLOAT_TRUNCATE: case FLOAT:
8555 case FIX: case UNSIGNED_FLOAT: case UNSIGNED_FIX: case ABS:
8556 case SQRT: case FFS:
8557 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, 0), sum, 0);
8558 break;
8559
8560 default:
8561 format_ptr = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
8562 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x)) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8563 switch (format_ptr[i])
8564 {
8565 case 'e':
8566 summarize_insn (XEXP (x, i), sum, 0);
8567 break;
8568
8569 case 'E':
8570 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8571 summarize_insn (XVECEXP (x, i, j), sum, 0);
8572 break;
8573
8574 case 'i':
8575 break;
8576
8577 default:
8578 gcc_unreachable ();
8579 }
8580 }
8581 }
8582
8583 /* Ensure a sufficient number of `trapb' insns are in the code when
8584 the user requests code with a trap precision of functions or
8585 instructions.
8586
8587 In naive mode, when the user requests a trap-precision of
8588 "instruction", a trapb is needed after every instruction that may
8589 generate a trap. This ensures that the code is resumption safe but
8590 it is also slow.
8591
8592 When optimizations are turned on, we delay issuing a trapb as long
8593 as possible. In this context, a trap shadow is the sequence of
8594 instructions that starts with a (potentially) trap generating
8595 instruction and extends to the next trapb or call_pal instruction
8596 (but GCC never generates call_pal by itself). We can delay (and
8597 therefore sometimes omit) a trapb subject to the following
8598 conditions:
8599
8600 (a) On entry to the trap shadow, if any Alpha register or memory
8601 location contains a value that is used as an operand value by some
8602 instruction in the trap shadow (live on entry), then no instruction
8603 in the trap shadow may modify the register or memory location.
8604
8605 (b) Within the trap shadow, the computation of the base register
8606 for a memory load or store instruction may not involve using the
8607 result of an instruction that might generate an UNPREDICTABLE
8608 result.
8609
8610 (c) Within the trap shadow, no register may be used more than once
8611 as a destination register. (This is to make life easier for the
8612 trap-handler.)
8613
8614 (d) The trap shadow may not include any branch instructions. */
8615
8616 static void
8617 alpha_handle_trap_shadows (void)
8618 {
8619 struct shadow_summary shadow;
8620 int trap_pending, exception_nesting;
8621 rtx i, n;
8622
8623 trap_pending = 0;
8624 exception_nesting = 0;
8625 shadow.used.i = 0;
8626 shadow.used.fp = 0;
8627 shadow.used.mem = 0;
8628 shadow.defd = shadow.used;
8629
8630 for (i = get_insns (); i ; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
8631 {
8632 if (NOTE_P (i))
8633 {
8634 switch (NOTE_KIND (i))
8635 {
8636 case NOTE_INSN_EH_REGION_BEG:
8637 exception_nesting++;
8638 if (trap_pending)
8639 goto close_shadow;
8640 break;
8641
8642 case NOTE_INSN_EH_REGION_END:
8643 exception_nesting--;
8644 if (trap_pending)
8645 goto close_shadow;
8646 break;
8647
8648 case NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG:
8649 if (trap_pending && alpha_tp >= ALPHA_TP_FUNC)
8650 goto close_shadow;
8651 break;
8652 }
8653 }
8654 else if (trap_pending)
8655 {
8656 if (alpha_tp == ALPHA_TP_FUNC)
8657 {
8658 if (JUMP_P (i)
8659 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == RETURN)
8660 goto close_shadow;
8661 }
8662 else if (alpha_tp == ALPHA_TP_INSN)
8663 {
8664 if (optimize > 0)
8665 {
8666 struct shadow_summary sum;
8667
8668 sum.used.i = 0;
8669 sum.used.fp = 0;
8670 sum.used.mem = 0;
8671 sum.defd = sum.used;
8672
8673 switch (GET_CODE (i))
8674 {
8675 case INSN:
8676 /* Annoyingly, get_attr_trap will die on these. */
8677 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == USE
8678 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == CLOBBER)
8679 break;
8680
8681 summarize_insn (PATTERN (i), &sum, 0);
8682
8683 if ((sum.defd.i & shadow.defd.i)
8684 || (sum.defd.fp & shadow.defd.fp))
8685 {
8686 /* (c) would be violated */
8687 goto close_shadow;
8688 }
8689
8690 /* Combine shadow with summary of current insn: */
8691 shadow.used.i |= sum.used.i;
8692 shadow.used.fp |= sum.used.fp;
8693 shadow.used.mem |= sum.used.mem;
8694 shadow.defd.i |= sum.defd.i;
8695 shadow.defd.fp |= sum.defd.fp;
8696 shadow.defd.mem |= sum.defd.mem;
8697
8698 if ((sum.defd.i & shadow.used.i)
8699 || (sum.defd.fp & shadow.used.fp)
8700 || (sum.defd.mem & shadow.used.mem))
8701 {
8702 /* (a) would be violated (also takes care of (b)) */
8703 gcc_assert (get_attr_trap (i) != TRAP_YES
8704 || (!(sum.defd.i & sum.used.i)
8705 && !(sum.defd.fp & sum.used.fp)));
8706
8707 goto close_shadow;
8708 }
8709 break;
8710
8711 case JUMP_INSN:
8712 case CALL_INSN:
8713 case CODE_LABEL:
8714 goto close_shadow;
8715
8716 default:
8717 gcc_unreachable ();
8718 }
8719 }
8720 else
8721 {
8722 close_shadow:
8723 n = emit_insn_before (gen_trapb (), i);
8724 PUT_MODE (n, TImode);
8725 PUT_MODE (i, TImode);
8726 trap_pending = 0;
8727 shadow.used.i = 0;
8728 shadow.used.fp = 0;
8729 shadow.used.mem = 0;
8730 shadow.defd = shadow.used;
8731 }
8732 }
8733 }
8734
8735 if ((exception_nesting > 0 || alpha_tp >= ALPHA_TP_FUNC)
8736 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (i)
8737 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) != USE
8738 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) != CLOBBER
8739 && get_attr_trap (i) == TRAP_YES)
8740 {
8741 if (optimize && !trap_pending)
8742 summarize_insn (PATTERN (i), &shadow, 0);
8743 trap_pending = 1;
8744 }
8745 }
8746 }
8747 \f
8748 /* Alpha can only issue instruction groups simultaneously if they are
8749 suitably aligned. This is very processor-specific. */
8750 /* There are a number of entries in alphaev4_insn_pipe and alphaev5_insn_pipe
8751 that are marked "fake". These instructions do not exist on that target,
8752 but it is possible to see these insns with deranged combinations of
8753 command-line options, such as "-mtune=ev4 -mmax". Instead of aborting,
8754 choose a result at random. */
8755
8756 enum alphaev4_pipe {
8757 EV4_STOP = 0,
8758 EV4_IB0 = 1,
8759 EV4_IB1 = 2,
8760 EV4_IBX = 4
8761 };
8762
8763 enum alphaev5_pipe {
8764 EV5_STOP = 0,
8765 EV5_NONE = 1,
8766 EV5_E01 = 2,
8767 EV5_E0 = 4,
8768 EV5_E1 = 8,
8769 EV5_FAM = 16,
8770 EV5_FA = 32,
8771 EV5_FM = 64
8772 };
8773
8774 static enum alphaev4_pipe
8775 alphaev4_insn_pipe (rtx insn)
8776 {
8777 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
8778 return EV4_STOP;
8779 if (get_attr_length (insn) != 4)
8780 return EV4_STOP;
8781
8782 switch (get_attr_type (insn))
8783 {
8784 case TYPE_ILD:
8785 case TYPE_LDSYM:
8786 case TYPE_FLD:
8787 case TYPE_LD_L:
8788 return EV4_IBX;
8789
8790 case TYPE_IADD:
8791 case TYPE_ILOG:
8792 case TYPE_ICMOV:
8793 case TYPE_ICMP:
8794 case TYPE_FST:
8795 case TYPE_SHIFT:
8796 case TYPE_IMUL:
8797 case TYPE_FBR:
8798 case TYPE_MVI: /* fake */
8799 return EV4_IB0;
8800
8801 case TYPE_IST:
8802 case TYPE_MISC:
8803 case TYPE_IBR:
8804 case TYPE_JSR:
8805 case TYPE_CALLPAL:
8806 case TYPE_FCPYS:
8807 case TYPE_FCMOV:
8808 case TYPE_FADD:
8809 case TYPE_FDIV:
8810 case TYPE_FMUL:
8811 case TYPE_ST_C:
8812 case TYPE_MB:
8813 case TYPE_FSQRT: /* fake */
8814 case TYPE_FTOI: /* fake */
8815 case TYPE_ITOF: /* fake */
8816 return EV4_IB1;
8817
8818 default:
8819 gcc_unreachable ();
8820 }
8821 }
8822
8823 static enum alphaev5_pipe
8824 alphaev5_insn_pipe (rtx insn)
8825 {
8826 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
8827 return EV5_STOP;
8828 if (get_attr_length (insn) != 4)
8829 return EV5_STOP;
8830
8831 switch (get_attr_type (insn))
8832 {
8833 case TYPE_ILD:
8834 case TYPE_FLD:
8835 case TYPE_LDSYM:
8836 case TYPE_IADD:
8837 case TYPE_ILOG:
8838 case TYPE_ICMOV:
8839 case TYPE_ICMP:
8840 return EV5_E01;
8841
8842 case TYPE_IST:
8843 case TYPE_FST:
8844 case TYPE_SHIFT:
8845 case TYPE_IMUL:
8846 case TYPE_MISC:
8847 case TYPE_MVI:
8848 case TYPE_LD_L:
8849 case TYPE_ST_C:
8850 case TYPE_MB:
8851 case TYPE_FTOI: /* fake */
8852 case TYPE_ITOF: /* fake */
8853 return EV5_E0;
8854
8855 case TYPE_IBR:
8856 case TYPE_JSR:
8857 case TYPE_CALLPAL:
8858 return EV5_E1;
8859
8860 case TYPE_FCPYS:
8861 return EV5_FAM;
8862
8863 case TYPE_FBR:
8864 case TYPE_FCMOV:
8865 case TYPE_FADD:
8866 case TYPE_FDIV:
8867 case TYPE_FSQRT: /* fake */
8868 return EV5_FA;
8869
8870 case TYPE_FMUL:
8871 return EV5_FM;
8872
8873 default:
8874 gcc_unreachable ();
8875 }
8876 }
8877
8878 /* IN_USE is a mask of the slots currently filled within the insn group.
8879 The mask bits come from alphaev4_pipe above. If EV4_IBX is set, then
8880 the insn in EV4_IB0 can be swapped by the hardware into EV4_IB1.
8881
8882 LEN is, of course, the length of the group in bytes. */
8883
8884 static rtx
8885 alphaev4_next_group (rtx insn, int *pin_use, int *plen)
8886 {
8887 int len, in_use;
8888
8889 len = in_use = 0;
8890
8891 if (! INSN_P (insn)
8892 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
8893 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE)
8894 goto next_and_done;
8895
8896 while (1)
8897 {
8898 enum alphaev4_pipe pipe;
8899
8900 pipe = alphaev4_insn_pipe (insn);
8901 switch (pipe)
8902 {
8903 case EV4_STOP:
8904 /* Force complex instructions to start new groups. */
8905 if (in_use)
8906 goto done;
8907
8908 /* If this is a completely unrecognized insn, it's an asm.
8909 We don't know how long it is, so record length as -1 to
8910 signal a needed realignment. */
8911 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
8912 len = -1;
8913 else
8914 len = get_attr_length (insn);
8915 goto next_and_done;
8916
8917 case EV4_IBX:
8918 if (in_use & EV4_IB0)
8919 {
8920 if (in_use & EV4_IB1)
8921 goto done;
8922 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
8923 }
8924 else
8925 in_use |= EV4_IB0 | EV4_IBX;
8926 break;
8927
8928 case EV4_IB0:
8929 if (in_use & EV4_IB0)
8930 {
8931 if (!(in_use & EV4_IBX) || (in_use & EV4_IB1))
8932 goto done;
8933 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
8934 }
8935 in_use |= EV4_IB0;
8936 break;
8937
8938 case EV4_IB1:
8939 if (in_use & EV4_IB1)
8940 goto done;
8941 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
8942 break;
8943
8944 default:
8945 gcc_unreachable ();
8946 }
8947 len += 4;
8948
8949 /* Haifa doesn't do well scheduling branches. */
8950 if (JUMP_P (insn))
8951 goto next_and_done;
8952
8953 next:
8954 insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
8955
8956 if (!insn || ! INSN_P (insn))
8957 goto done;
8958
8959 /* Let Haifa tell us where it thinks insn group boundaries are. */
8960 if (GET_MODE (insn) == TImode)
8961 goto done;
8962
8963 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CLOBBER || GET_CODE (insn) == USE)
8964 goto next;
8965 }
8966
8967 next_and_done:
8968 insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
8969
8970 done:
8971 *plen = len;
8972 *pin_use = in_use;
8973 return insn;
8974 }
8975
8976 /* IN_USE is a mask of the slots currently filled within the insn group.
8977 The mask bits come from alphaev5_pipe above. If EV5_E01 is set, then
8978 the insn in EV5_E0 can be swapped by the hardware into EV5_E1.
8979
8980 LEN is, of course, the length of the group in bytes. */
8981
8982 static rtx
8983 alphaev5_next_group (rtx insn, int *pin_use, int *plen)
8984 {
8985 int len, in_use;
8986
8987 len = in_use = 0;
8988
8989 if (! INSN_P (insn)
8990 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER
8991 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE)
8992 goto next_and_done;
8993
8994 while (1)
8995 {
8996 enum alphaev5_pipe pipe;
8997
8998 pipe = alphaev5_insn_pipe (insn);
8999 switch (pipe)
9000 {
9001 case EV5_STOP:
9002 /* Force complex instructions to start new groups. */
9003 if (in_use)
9004 goto done;
9005
9006 /* If this is a completely unrecognized insn, it's an asm.
9007 We don't know how long it is, so record length as -1 to
9008 signal a needed realignment. */
9009 if (recog_memoized (insn) < 0)
9010 len = -1;
9011 else
9012 len = get_attr_length (insn);
9013 goto next_and_done;
9014
9015 /* ??? Most of the places below, we would like to assert never
9016 happen, as it would indicate an error either in Haifa, or
9017 in the scheduling description. Unfortunately, Haifa never
9018 schedules the last instruction of the BB, so we don't have
9019 an accurate TI bit to go off. */
9020 case EV5_E01:
9021 if (in_use & EV5_E0)
9022 {
9023 if (in_use & EV5_E1)
9024 goto done;
9025 in_use |= EV5_E1;
9026 }
9027 else
9028 in_use |= EV5_E0 | EV5_E01;
9029 break;
9030
9031 case EV5_E0:
9032 if (in_use & EV5_E0)
9033 {
9034 if (!(in_use & EV5_E01) || (in_use & EV5_E1))
9035 goto done;
9036 in_use |= EV5_E1;
9037 }
9038 in_use |= EV5_E0;
9039 break;
9040
9041 case EV5_E1:
9042 if (in_use & EV5_E1)
9043 goto done;
9044 in_use |= EV5_E1;
9045 break;
9046
9047 case EV5_FAM:
9048 if (in_use & EV5_FA)
9049 {
9050 if (in_use & EV5_FM)
9051 goto done;
9052 in_use |= EV5_FM;
9053 }
9054 else
9055 in_use |= EV5_FA | EV5_FAM;
9056 break;
9057
9058 case EV5_FA:
9059 if (in_use & EV5_FA)
9060 goto done;
9061 in_use |= EV5_FA;
9062 break;
9063
9064 case EV5_FM:
9065 if (in_use & EV5_FM)
9066 goto done;
9067 in_use |= EV5_FM;
9068 break;
9069
9070 case EV5_NONE:
9071 break;
9072
9073 default:
9074 gcc_unreachable ();
9075 }
9076 len += 4;
9077
9078 /* Haifa doesn't do well scheduling branches. */
9079 /* ??? If this is predicted not-taken, slotting continues, except
9080 that no more IBR, FBR, or JSR insns may be slotted. */
9081 if (JUMP_P (insn))
9082 goto next_and_done;
9083
9084 next:
9085 insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
9086
9087 if (!insn || ! INSN_P (insn))
9088 goto done;
9089
9090 /* Let Haifa tell us where it thinks insn group boundaries are. */
9091 if (GET_MODE (insn) == TImode)
9092 goto done;
9093
9094 if (GET_CODE (insn) == CLOBBER || GET_CODE (insn) == USE)
9095 goto next;
9096 }
9097
9098 next_and_done:
9099 insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
9100
9101 done:
9102 *plen = len;
9103 *pin_use = in_use;
9104 return insn;
9105 }
9106
9107 static rtx
9108 alphaev4_next_nop (int *pin_use)
9109 {
9110 int in_use = *pin_use;
9111 rtx nop;
9112
9113 if (!(in_use & EV4_IB0))
9114 {
9115 in_use |= EV4_IB0;
9116 nop = gen_nop ();
9117 }
9118 else if ((in_use & (EV4_IBX|EV4_IB1)) == EV4_IBX)
9119 {
9120 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
9121 nop = gen_nop ();
9122 }
9123 else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV4_IB1))
9124 {
9125 in_use |= EV4_IB1;
9126 nop = gen_fnop ();
9127 }
9128 else
9129 nop = gen_unop ();
9130
9131 *pin_use = in_use;
9132 return nop;
9133 }
9134
9135 static rtx
9136 alphaev5_next_nop (int *pin_use)
9137 {
9138 int in_use = *pin_use;
9139 rtx nop;
9140
9141 if (!(in_use & EV5_E1))
9142 {
9143 in_use |= EV5_E1;
9144 nop = gen_nop ();
9145 }
9146 else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV5_FA))
9147 {
9148 in_use |= EV5_FA;
9149 nop = gen_fnop ();
9150 }
9151 else if (TARGET_FP && !(in_use & EV5_FM))
9152 {
9153 in_use |= EV5_FM;
9154 nop = gen_fnop ();
9155 }
9156 else
9157 nop = gen_unop ();
9158
9159 *pin_use = in_use;
9160 return nop;
9161 }
9162
9163 /* The instruction group alignment main loop. */
9164
9165 static void
9166 alpha_align_insns (unsigned int max_align,
9167 rtx (*next_group) (rtx, int *, int *),
9168 rtx (*next_nop) (int *))
9169 {
9170 /* ALIGN is the known alignment for the insn group. */
9171 unsigned int align;
9172 /* OFS is the offset of the current insn in the insn group. */
9173 int ofs;
9174 int prev_in_use, in_use, len, ldgp;
9175 rtx i, next;
9176
9177 /* Let shorten branches care for assigning alignments to code labels. */
9178 shorten_branches (get_insns ());
9179
9180 if (align_functions < 4)
9181 align = 4;
9182 else if ((unsigned int) align_functions < max_align)
9183 align = align_functions;
9184 else
9185 align = max_align;
9186
9187 ofs = prev_in_use = 0;
9188 i = get_insns ();
9189 if (NOTE_P (i))
9190 i = next_nonnote_insn (i);
9191
9192 ldgp = alpha_function_needs_gp ? 8 : 0;
9193
9194 while (i)
9195 {
9196 next = (*next_group) (i, &in_use, &len);
9197
9198 /* When we see a label, resync alignment etc. */
9199 if (LABEL_P (i))
9200 {
9201 unsigned int new_align = 1 << label_to_alignment (i);
9202
9203 if (new_align >= align)
9204 {
9205 align = new_align < max_align ? new_align : max_align;
9206 ofs = 0;
9207 }
9208
9209 else if (ofs & (new_align-1))
9210 ofs = (ofs | (new_align-1)) + 1;
9211 gcc_assert (!len);
9212 }
9213
9214 /* Handle complex instructions special. */
9215 else if (in_use == 0)
9216 {
9217 /* Asms will have length < 0. This is a signal that we have
9218 lost alignment knowledge. Assume, however, that the asm
9219 will not mis-align instructions. */
9220 if (len < 0)
9221 {
9222 ofs = 0;
9223 align = 4;
9224 len = 0;
9225 }
9226 }
9227
9228 /* If the known alignment is smaller than the recognized insn group,
9229 realign the output. */
9230 else if ((int) align < len)
9231 {
9232 unsigned int new_log_align = len > 8 ? 4 : 3;
9233 rtx prev, where;
9234
9235 where = prev = prev_nonnote_insn (i);
9236 if (!where || !LABEL_P (where))
9237 where = i;
9238
9239 /* Can't realign between a call and its gp reload. */
9240 if (! (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS
9241 && prev && CALL_P (prev)))
9242 {
9243 emit_insn_before (gen_realign (GEN_INT (new_log_align)), where);
9244 align = 1 << new_log_align;
9245 ofs = 0;
9246 }
9247 }
9248
9249 /* We may not insert padding inside the initial ldgp sequence. */
9250 else if (ldgp > 0)
9251 ldgp -= len;
9252
9253 /* If the group won't fit in the same INT16 as the previous,
9254 we need to add padding to keep the group together. Rather
9255 than simply leaving the insn filling to the assembler, we
9256 can make use of the knowledge of what sorts of instructions
9257 were issued in the previous group to make sure that all of
9258 the added nops are really free. */
9259 else if (ofs + len > (int) align)
9260 {
9261 int nop_count = (align - ofs) / 4;
9262 rtx where;
9263
9264 /* Insert nops before labels, branches, and calls to truly merge
9265 the execution of the nops with the previous instruction group. */
9266 where = prev_nonnote_insn (i);
9267 if (where)
9268 {
9269 if (LABEL_P (where))
9270 {
9271 rtx where2 = prev_nonnote_insn (where);
9272 if (where2 && JUMP_P (where2))
9273 where = where2;
9274 }
9275 else if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (where))
9276 where = i;
9277 }
9278 else
9279 where = i;
9280
9281 do
9282 emit_insn_before ((*next_nop)(&prev_in_use), where);
9283 while (--nop_count);
9284 ofs = 0;
9285 }
9286
9287 ofs = (ofs + len) & (align - 1);
9288 prev_in_use = in_use;
9289 i = next;
9290 }
9291 }
9292
9293 /* Insert an unop between a noreturn function call and GP load. */
9294
9295 static void
9296 alpha_pad_noreturn (void)
9297 {
9298 rtx insn, next;
9299
9300 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
9301 {
9302 if (! (CALL_P (insn)
9303 && find_reg_note (insn, REG_NORETURN, NULL_RTX)))
9304 continue;
9305
9306 /* Make sure we do not split a call and its corresponding
9307 CALL_ARG_LOCATION note. */
9308 if (CALL_P (insn))
9309 {
9310 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
9311 if (next && NOTE_P (next)
9312 && NOTE_KIND (next) == NOTE_INSN_CALL_ARG_LOCATION)
9313 insn = next;
9314 }
9315
9316 next = next_active_insn (insn);
9317
9318 if (next)
9319 {
9320 rtx pat = PATTERN (next);
9321
9322 if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET
9323 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (pat)) == UNSPEC_VOLATILE
9324 && XINT (SET_SRC (pat), 1) == UNSPECV_LDGP1)
9325 emit_insn_after (gen_unop (), insn);
9326 }
9327 }
9328 }
9329 \f
9330 /* Machine dependent reorg pass. */
9331
9332 static void
9333 alpha_reorg (void)
9334 {
9335 /* Workaround for a linker error that triggers when an
9336 exception handler immediatelly follows a noreturn function.
9337
9338 The instruction stream from an object file:
9339
9340 54: 00 40 5b 6b jsr ra,(t12),58 <__func+0x58>
9341 58: 00 00 ba 27 ldah gp,0(ra)
9342 5c: 00 00 bd 23 lda gp,0(gp)
9343 60: 00 00 7d a7 ldq t12,0(gp)
9344 64: 00 40 5b 6b jsr ra,(t12),68 <__func+0x68>
9345
9346 was converted in the final link pass to:
9347
9348 fdb24: a0 03 40 d3 bsr ra,fe9a8 <_called_func+0x8>
9349 fdb28: 00 00 fe 2f unop
9350 fdb2c: 00 00 fe 2f unop
9351 fdb30: 30 82 7d a7 ldq t12,-32208(gp)
9352 fdb34: 00 40 5b 6b jsr ra,(t12),fdb38 <__func+0x68>
9353
9354 GP load instructions were wrongly cleared by the linker relaxation
9355 pass. This workaround prevents removal of GP loads by inserting
9356 an unop instruction between a noreturn function call and
9357 exception handler prologue. */
9358
9359 if (current_function_has_exception_handlers ())
9360 alpha_pad_noreturn ();
9361
9362 if (alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_PROG || flag_exceptions)
9363 alpha_handle_trap_shadows ();
9364
9365 /* Due to the number of extra trapb insns, don't bother fixing up
9366 alignment when trap precision is instruction. Moreover, we can
9367 only do our job when sched2 is run. */
9368 if (optimize && !optimize_size
9369 && alpha_tp != ALPHA_TP_INSN
9370 && flag_schedule_insns_after_reload)
9371 {
9372 if (alpha_tune == PROCESSOR_EV4)
9373 alpha_align_insns (8, alphaev4_next_group, alphaev4_next_nop);
9374 else if (alpha_tune == PROCESSOR_EV5)
9375 alpha_align_insns (16, alphaev5_next_group, alphaev5_next_nop);
9376 }
9377 }
9378 \f
9379 #ifdef HAVE_STAMP_H
9380 #include <stamp.h>
9381 #endif
9382
9383 static void
9384 alpha_file_start (void)
9385 {
9386 #ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF
9387 /* If emitting dwarf2 debug information, we cannot generate a .file
9388 directive to start the file, as it will conflict with dwarf2out
9389 file numbers. So it's only useful when emitting mdebug output. */
9390 targetm.asm_file_start_file_directive = (write_symbols == DBX_DEBUG);
9391 #endif
9392
9393 default_file_start ();
9394 #ifdef MS_STAMP
9395 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.verstamp %d %d\n", MS_STAMP, LS_STAMP);
9396 #endif
9397
9398 fputs ("\t.set noreorder\n", asm_out_file);
9399 fputs ("\t.set volatile\n", asm_out_file);
9400 if (TARGET_ABI_OSF)
9401 fputs ("\t.set noat\n", asm_out_file);
9402 if (TARGET_EXPLICIT_RELOCS)
9403 fputs ("\t.set nomacro\n", asm_out_file);
9404 if (TARGET_SUPPORT_ARCH | TARGET_BWX | TARGET_MAX | TARGET_FIX | TARGET_CIX)
9405 {
9406 const char *arch;
9407
9408 if (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV6 || TARGET_FIX || TARGET_CIX)
9409 arch = "ev6";
9410 else if (TARGET_MAX)
9411 arch = "pca56";
9412 else if (TARGET_BWX)
9413 arch = "ev56";
9414 else if (alpha_cpu == PROCESSOR_EV5)
9415 arch = "ev5";
9416 else
9417 arch = "ev4";
9418
9419 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.arch %s\n", arch);
9420 }
9421 }
9422
9423 #ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF
9424 /* Since we don't have a .dynbss section, we should not allow global
9425 relocations in the .rodata section. */
9426
9427 static int
9428 alpha_elf_reloc_rw_mask (void)
9429 {
9430 return flag_pic ? 3 : 2;
9431 }
9432
9433 /* Return a section for X. The only special thing we do here is to
9434 honor small data. */
9435
9436 static section *
9437 alpha_elf_select_rtx_section (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x,
9438 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT align)
9439 {
9440 if (TARGET_SMALL_DATA && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= g_switch_value)
9441 /* ??? Consider using mergeable sdata sections. */
9442 return sdata_section;
9443 else
9444 return default_elf_select_rtx_section (mode, x, align);
9445 }
9446
9447 static unsigned int
9448 alpha_elf_section_type_flags (tree decl, const char *name, int reloc)
9449 {
9450 unsigned int flags = 0;
9451
9452 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
9453 || strncmp (name, ".sdata.", 7) == 0
9454 || strncmp (name, ".gnu.linkonce.s.", 16) == 0
9455 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
9456 || strncmp (name, ".sbss.", 6) == 0
9457 || strncmp (name, ".gnu.linkonce.sb.", 17) == 0)
9458 flags = SECTION_SMALL;
9459
9460 flags |= default_section_type_flags (decl, name, reloc);
9461 return flags;
9462 }
9463 #endif /* OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF */
9464 \f
9465 /* Structure to collect function names for final output in link section. */
9466 /* Note that items marked with GTY can't be ifdef'ed out. */
9467
9468 enum reloc_kind
9469 {
9470 KIND_LINKAGE,
9471 KIND_CODEADDR
9472 };
9473
9474 struct GTY(()) alpha_links
9475 {
9476 rtx func;
9477 rtx linkage;
9478 enum reloc_kind rkind;
9479 };
9480
9481 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
9482
9483 /* Return the VMS argument type corresponding to MODE. */
9484
9485 enum avms_arg_type
9486 alpha_arg_type (enum machine_mode mode)
9487 {
9488 switch (mode)
9489 {
9490 case SFmode:
9491 return TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? FF : FS;
9492 case DFmode:
9493 return TARGET_FLOAT_VAX ? FD : FT;
9494 default:
9495 return I64;
9496 }
9497 }
9498
9499 /* Return an rtx for an integer representing the VMS Argument Information
9500 register value. */
9501
9502 rtx
9503 alpha_arg_info_reg_val (CUMULATIVE_ARGS cum)
9504 {
9505 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT regval = cum.num_args;
9506 int i;
9507
9508 for (i = 0; i < 6; i++)
9509 regval |= ((int) cum.atypes[i]) << (i * 3 + 8);
9510
9511 return GEN_INT (regval);
9512 }
9513 \f
9514
9515 /* Return a SYMBOL_REF representing the reference to the .linkage entry
9516 of function FUNC built for calls made from CFUNDECL. LFLAG is 1 if
9517 this is the reference to the linkage pointer value, 0 if this is the
9518 reference to the function entry value. RFLAG is 1 if this a reduced
9519 reference (code address only), 0 if this is a full reference. */
9520
9521 rtx
9522 alpha_use_linkage (rtx func, bool lflag, bool rflag)
9523 {
9524 struct alpha_links *al = NULL;
9525 const char *name = XSTR (func, 0);
9526
9527 if (cfun->machine->links)
9528 {
9529 splay_tree_node lnode;
9530
9531 /* Is this name already defined? */
9532 lnode = splay_tree_lookup (cfun->machine->links, (splay_tree_key) name);
9533 if (lnode)
9534 al = (struct alpha_links *) lnode->value;
9535 }
9536 else
9537 cfun->machine->links = splay_tree_new_ggc
9538 ((splay_tree_compare_fn) strcmp,
9539 ggc_alloc_splay_tree_str_alpha_links_splay_tree_s,
9540 ggc_alloc_splay_tree_str_alpha_links_splay_tree_node_s);
9541
9542 if (al == NULL)
9543 {
9544 size_t buf_len;
9545 char *linksym;
9546 tree id;
9547
9548 if (name[0] == '*')
9549 name++;
9550
9551 /* Follow transparent alias, as this is used for CRTL translations. */
9552 id = maybe_get_identifier (name);
9553 if (id)
9554 {
9555 while (IDENTIFIER_TRANSPARENT_ALIAS (id))
9556 id = TREE_CHAIN (id);
9557 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (id);
9558 }
9559
9560 buf_len = strlen (name) + 8 + 9;
9561 linksym = (char *) alloca (buf_len);
9562 snprintf (linksym, buf_len, "$%d..%s..lk", cfun->funcdef_no, name);
9563
9564 al = ggc_alloc_alpha_links ();
9565 al->func = func;
9566 al->linkage = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, ggc_strdup (linksym));
9567
9568 splay_tree_insert (cfun->machine->links,
9569 (splay_tree_key) ggc_strdup (name),
9570 (splay_tree_value) al);
9571 }
9572
9573 al->rkind = rflag ? KIND_CODEADDR : KIND_LINKAGE;
9574
9575 if (lflag)
9576 return gen_rtx_MEM (Pmode, plus_constant (al->linkage, 8));
9577 else
9578 return al->linkage;
9579 }
9580
9581 static int
9582 alpha_write_one_linkage (splay_tree_node node, void *data)
9583 {
9584 const char *const name = (const char *) node->key;
9585 struct alpha_links *link = (struct alpha_links *) node->value;
9586 FILE *stream = (FILE *) data;
9587
9588 ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (stream, XSTR (link->linkage, 0));
9589 if (link->rkind == KIND_CODEADDR)
9590 {
9591 /* External and used, request code address. */
9592 fprintf (stream, "\t.code_address ");
9593 }
9594 else
9595 {
9596 if (!SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (link->func)
9597 && SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (link->func))
9598 {
9599 /* Locally defined, build linkage pair. */
9600 fprintf (stream, "\t.quad %s..en\n", name);
9601 fprintf (stream, "\t.quad ");
9602 }
9603 else
9604 {
9605 /* External, request linkage pair. */
9606 fprintf (stream, "\t.linkage ");
9607 }
9608 }
9609 assemble_name (stream, name);
9610 fputs ("\n", stream);
9611
9612 return 0;
9613 }
9614
9615 static void
9616 alpha_write_linkage (FILE *stream, const char *funname)
9617 {
9618 fprintf (stream, "\t.link\n");
9619 fprintf (stream, "\t.align 3\n");
9620 in_section = NULL;
9621
9622 #ifdef TARGET_VMS_CRASH_DEBUG
9623 fputs ("\t.name ", stream);
9624 assemble_name (stream, funname);
9625 fputs ("..na\n", stream);
9626 #endif
9627
9628 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (stream, funname);
9629 fprintf (stream, "\t.pdesc ");
9630 assemble_name (stream, funname);
9631 fprintf (stream, "..en,%s\n",
9632 alpha_procedure_type == PT_STACK ? "stack"
9633 : alpha_procedure_type == PT_REGISTER ? "reg" : "null");
9634
9635 if (cfun->machine->links)
9636 {
9637 splay_tree_foreach (cfun->machine->links, alpha_write_one_linkage, stream);
9638 /* splay_tree_delete (func->links); */
9639 }
9640 }
9641
9642 /* Switch to an arbitrary section NAME with attributes as specified
9643 by FLAGS. ALIGN specifies any known alignment requirements for
9644 the section; 0 if the default should be used. */
9645
9646 static void
9647 vms_asm_named_section (const char *name, unsigned int flags,
9648 tree decl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9649 {
9650 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
9651 fprintf (asm_out_file, ".section\t%s", name);
9652
9653 if (flags & SECTION_DEBUG)
9654 fprintf (asm_out_file, ",NOWRT");
9655
9656 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
9657 }
9658
9659 /* Record an element in the table of global constructors. SYMBOL is
9660 a SYMBOL_REF of the function to be called; PRIORITY is a number
9661 between 0 and MAX_INIT_PRIORITY.
9662
9663 Differs from default_ctors_section_asm_out_constructor in that the
9664 width of the .ctors entry is always 64 bits, rather than the 32 bits
9665 used by a normal pointer. */
9666
9667 static void
9668 vms_asm_out_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9669 {
9670 switch_to_section (ctors_section);
9671 assemble_align (BITS_PER_WORD);
9672 assemble_integer (symbol, UNITS_PER_WORD, BITS_PER_WORD, 1);
9673 }
9674
9675 static void
9676 vms_asm_out_destructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9677 {
9678 switch_to_section (dtors_section);
9679 assemble_align (BITS_PER_WORD);
9680 assemble_integer (symbol, UNITS_PER_WORD, BITS_PER_WORD, 1);
9681 }
9682 #else
9683 rtx
9684 alpha_use_linkage (rtx func ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9685 bool lflag ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9686 bool rflag ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9687 {
9688 return NULL_RTX;
9689 }
9690
9691 #endif /* TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS */
9692 \f
9693 static void
9694 alpha_init_libfuncs (void)
9695 {
9696 if (TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS)
9697 {
9698 /* Use the VMS runtime library functions for division and
9699 remainder. */
9700 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SImode, "OTS$DIV_I");
9701 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DImode, "OTS$DIV_L");
9702 set_optab_libfunc (udiv_optab, SImode, "OTS$DIV_UI");
9703 set_optab_libfunc (udiv_optab, DImode, "OTS$DIV_UL");
9704 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, SImode, "OTS$REM_I");
9705 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, DImode, "OTS$REM_L");
9706 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, SImode, "OTS$REM_UI");
9707 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, DImode, "OTS$REM_UL");
9708 abort_libfunc = init_one_libfunc ("decc$abort");
9709 memcmp_libfunc = init_one_libfunc ("decc$memcmp");
9710 #ifdef MEM_LIBFUNCS_INIT
9711 MEM_LIBFUNCS_INIT;
9712 #endif
9713 }
9714 }
9715
9716 /* On the Alpha, we use this to disable the floating-point registers
9717 when they don't exist. */
9718
9719 static void
9720 alpha_conditional_register_usage (void)
9721 {
9722 int i;
9723 if (! TARGET_FPREGS)
9724 for (i = 32; i < 63; i++)
9725 fixed_regs[i] = call_used_regs[i] = 1;
9726 }
9727 \f
9728 /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
9729 #if TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
9730 # undef TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9731 # define TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE vms_attribute_table
9732 # undef TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
9733 # define TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE alpha_vms_can_eliminate
9734 #endif
9735
9736 #undef TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
9737 #define TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P alpha_in_small_data_p
9738
9739 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
9740 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.word\t"
9741 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
9742 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.quad\t"
9743
9744 /* Default unaligned ops are provided for ELF systems. To get unaligned
9745 data for non-ELF systems, we have to turn off auto alignment. */
9746 #if !defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF) || TARGET_ABI_OPEN_VMS
9747 #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
9748 #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.word\t"
9749 #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
9750 #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.long\t"
9751 #undef TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
9752 #define TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP "\t.align 0\n\t.quad\t"
9753 #endif
9754
9755 #ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF
9756 #undef TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
9757 #define TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK alpha_elf_reloc_rw_mask
9758 #undef TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
9759 #define TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION alpha_elf_select_rtx_section
9760 #undef TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
9761 #define TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS alpha_elf_section_type_flags
9762 #endif
9763
9764 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
9765 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE alpha_output_function_end_prologue
9766
9767 #undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
9768 #define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS alpha_init_libfuncs
9769
9770 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
9771 #define TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS alpha_legitimize_address
9772
9773 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
9774 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START alpha_file_start
9775 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
9776 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE true
9777
9778 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
9779 #define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST alpha_adjust_cost
9780 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
9781 #define TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE alpha_issue_rate
9782 #undef TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
9783 #define TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD \
9784 alpha_multipass_dfa_lookahead
9785
9786 #undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS
9787 #define TARGET_HAVE_TLS HAVE_AS_TLS
9788
9789 #undef TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
9790 #define TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL alpha_builtin_decl
9791 #undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
9792 #define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS alpha_init_builtins
9793 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
9794 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN alpha_expand_builtin
9795 #undef TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
9796 #define TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN alpha_fold_builtin
9797
9798 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
9799 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL alpha_function_ok_for_sibcall
9800 #undef TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P
9801 #define TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P alpha_cannot_copy_insn_p
9802 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
9803 #define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P alpha_legitimate_constant_p
9804 #undef TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
9805 #define TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM alpha_cannot_force_const_mem
9806
9807 #if TARGET_ABI_OSF
9808 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
9809 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK alpha_output_mi_thunk_osf
9810 #undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
9811 #define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK hook_bool_const_tree_hwi_hwi_const_tree_true
9812 #undef TARGET_STDARG_OPTIMIZE_HOOK
9813 #define TARGET_STDARG_OPTIMIZE_HOOK alpha_stdarg_optimize_hook
9814 #endif
9815
9816 /* Use 16-bits anchor. */
9817 #undef TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
9818 #define TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET -0x7fff - 1
9819 #undef TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
9820 #define TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET 0x7fff
9821 #undef TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
9822 #define TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P hook_bool_mode_const_rtx_true
9823
9824 #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
9825 #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS alpha_rtx_costs
9826 #undef TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
9827 #define TARGET_ADDRESS_COST hook_int_rtx_bool_0
9828
9829 #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
9830 #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG alpha_reorg
9831
9832 #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
9833 #define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE default_promote_function_mode_always_promote
9834 #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
9835 #define TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES hook_bool_const_tree_false
9836 #undef TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
9837 #define TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY alpha_return_in_memory
9838 #undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
9839 #define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE alpha_pass_by_reference
9840 #undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
9841 #define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS alpha_setup_incoming_varargs
9842 #undef TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
9843 #define TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING hook_bool_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_true
9844 #undef TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
9845 #define TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED hook_bool_CUMULATIVE_ARGS_true
9846 #undef TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
9847 #define TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG alpha_split_complex_arg
9848 #undef TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
9849 #define TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR alpha_gimplify_va_arg
9850 #undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
9851 #define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES alpha_arg_partial_bytes
9852 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
9853 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG alpha_function_arg
9854 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
9855 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE alpha_function_arg_advance
9856 #undef TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
9857 #define TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT alpha_trampoline_init
9858
9859 #undef TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
9860 #define TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS alpha_instantiate_decls
9861
9862 #undef TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
9863 #define TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD alpha_secondary_reload
9864
9865 #undef TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
9866 #define TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P alpha_scalar_mode_supported_p
9867 #undef TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
9868 #define TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P alpha_vector_mode_supported_p
9869
9870 #undef TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
9871 #define TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST alpha_build_builtin_va_list
9872
9873 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START
9874 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_VA_START alpha_va_start
9875
9876 /* The Alpha architecture does not require sequential consistency. See
9877 http://www.cs.umd.edu/~pugh/java/memoryModel/AlphaReordering.html
9878 for an example of how it can be violated in practice. */
9879 #undef TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
9880 #define TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING true
9881
9882 #undef TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9883 #define TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE alpha_option_override
9884
9885 #ifdef TARGET_ALTERNATE_LONG_DOUBLE_MANGLING
9886 #undef TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
9887 #define TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE alpha_mangle_type
9888 #endif
9889
9890 #undef TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
9891 #define TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P alpha_legitimate_address_p
9892
9893 #undef TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
9894 #define TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE alpha_conditional_register_usage
9895
9896 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
9897
9898 \f
9899 #include "gt-alpha.h"